blob: 4409380bd7a82ab80ba1c5f55d23dee683f1e7f2 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000048#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000049#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000051#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000053#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000054#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000059#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000060#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000061#include <climits>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000062#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000063using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000064using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000065
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000066STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
67STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
68STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
69STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
70STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000071
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000072namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000073 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
74 : public FunctionPass,
75 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000076 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000077 std::vector<Instruction*> Worklist;
78 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000079 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000080 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000081 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000082 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000083 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass((intptr_t)&ID) {}
84
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000085 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
86 /// isn't already in it.
87 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
88 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())))
89 Worklist.push_back(I);
90 }
91
92 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
93 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
94 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
95 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
96
97 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
98 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
99
100 WorklistMap.erase(It);
101 }
102
103 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
104 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
105 Worklist.pop_back();
106 WorklistMap.erase(I);
107 return I;
108 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000109
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000110
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000111 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
112 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
113 /// now.
114 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000115 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000116 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000118 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000119 }
120
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000121 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
122 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
123 ///
124 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000125 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
126 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000127 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000128 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000129
130 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
131 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
132 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
133 ///
134 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
135 ///
136 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
137 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
138
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000139 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
140 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000141 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000142 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000143 *i = UndefValue::get(Op->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000144 }
145
146 return R;
147 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000148
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000149 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000150 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000151
152 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000153
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000154 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000155 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000156 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000157 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000158 }
159
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000160 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
161
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000162 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
163 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
164 // Return Value:
165 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000166 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000167 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000168 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000169 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000172 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
175 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
176 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000177 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
178 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000182 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
183 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000185 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
186 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
187 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
188 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000189 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
190 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000191 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
192 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
193 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000194 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
195 Instruction *LHS,
196 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000197 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
198 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000199
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000200 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
201 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000202 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000203 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000204 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
205 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000206 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000207 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
208 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000210 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000211 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000212 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
213 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000214 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
215 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
216 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000217 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000218 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000219 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
220 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000221 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000222 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
223 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000224 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
225 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000226 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000227 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000228 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000229 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000230 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000231 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000232 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000233 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000234 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000235 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000236
237 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000238 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000239
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000240 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000241 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000242 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000243 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000244 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
245 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000246 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000247
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000248 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000249 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
250 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
251 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000252 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000253 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
254 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000255 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
256 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000257 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000258 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000259 }
260
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000261 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
262 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
263 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000264 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
265 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000266 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000267
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000268 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000269 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000270
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000271 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000272 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000273 return C;
274 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000275
276 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
277 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
278 }
279
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000280
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000281 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
282 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
283 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
284 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
285 // modified.
286 //
287 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000288 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000289 if (&I != V) {
290 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
291 return &I;
292 } else {
293 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
294 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000295 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000296 return &I;
297 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000298 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000299
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000300 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
301 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
302 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
303 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
304 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
305 //
306 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
307 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
308 if (Old != New)
309 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
310 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000311 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000312 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000313 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000314 return true;
315 }
316
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000317 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
318 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
319 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
320 // this function.
321 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
322 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
323 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000324 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000325 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000326 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
327 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000328
329 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
330 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
331 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
332 }
333
334 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
335 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
336 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
337 }
338 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
339 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
340 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000341
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000342 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000343 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
344 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
345 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
346 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000347 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
348 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000349 Instruction *InsertBefore);
350
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000351 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
352 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000353 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000354
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000355 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
356 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
357 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
358
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000359 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
360 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000361 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
362 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
363 unsigned Depth = 0);
364
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000365 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
366 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
367
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000368 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
369 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
370 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
371 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
372
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000373 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
374 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
375 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
376 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000377 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
378
379
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000380 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
381 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000382
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000383 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000384 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000385 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000386 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000387 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000388 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000389 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000390 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000391 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000392
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000393
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000394 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000395
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000396 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
397 unsigned CastOpc,
398 int &NumCastsRemoved);
399 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
400 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000401
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000402 };
403}
404
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000405char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
406static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
407X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
408
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000409// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000410// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000411static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
412 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
413 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000414 return 3;
415 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000416 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000417 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
418 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000419}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000420
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000421// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
422// it.
423static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000424 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000425}
426
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000427// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
428// though a va_arg area...
429static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000430 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
431 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
432 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000433 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000434 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000435}
436
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000437/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst or a constant
438/// expression bitcast, return the operand value, otherwise return null.
439static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
440 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000441 return I->getOperand(0);
442 else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000443 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000444 return CE->getOperand(0);
445 return 0;
446}
447
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000448/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
449/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000450static Instruction::CastOps
451isEliminableCastPair(
452 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
453 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
454 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
455 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
456) {
457
458 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
459 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000460
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000461 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
462 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
463 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000464
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000465 return Instruction::CastOps(
466 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
467 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000468}
469
470/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
471/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
472/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000473static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
474 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000475 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
476
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000477 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000478 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000479 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000480 return false;
481 return true;
482}
483
484/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
485/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
486/// casts that are known to not do anything...
487///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000488Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
489 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000490 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
491 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
492 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000493 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000494
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000495 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000496}
497
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000498// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
499// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000500//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000501// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
502// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
503// binary operators.
504//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000505// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
506// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000507//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000508bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000509 bool Changed = false;
510 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
511 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000512
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000513 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
514 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000515 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
516 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
517 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000518 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
519 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
520 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000521 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
522 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
523 return true;
524 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
525 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
526 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
527 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
528 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
529
530 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000531 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000532 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000533 Op1->getOperand(0),
534 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000535 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000536 I.setOperand(0, New);
537 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
538 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000539 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000540 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000541 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000542}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000543
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000544/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
545/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
546/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
547bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
548 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
549 return false;
550 I.swapOperands();
551 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
552 return true;
553}
554
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000555// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
556// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000557//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000558static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
559 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000560 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000561
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000562 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
563 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
564 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000565
566 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
567 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
568 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
569
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000570 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000571}
572
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000573static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
574 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000575 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000576
577 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000578 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000579 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000580 return 0;
581}
582
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000583// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
584// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000585// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
586// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000587//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000588static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000589 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000590 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000591 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000592 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000593 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000594 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000595 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000596 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000597 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000598 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000599 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000600 return I->getOperand(0);
601 }
602 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000603 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000604}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000605
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000606/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
607/// expression, return it.
608static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
609 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
610 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
611 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
612 return cast<User>(V);
613 return false;
614}
615
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000616/// getOpcode - If this is an Instruction or a ConstantExpr, return the
617/// opcode value. Otherwise return UserOp1.
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000618static unsigned getOpcode(const Value *V) {
619 if (const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000620 return I->getOpcode();
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000621 if (const ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000622 return CE->getOpcode();
623 // Use UserOp1 to mean there's no opcode.
624 return Instruction::UserOp1;
625}
626
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000627/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000628static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000629 APInt Val(C->getValue());
630 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000631}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000632/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000633static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000634 APInt Val(C->getValue());
635 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000636}
637/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
638static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
639 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
640}
641/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
642static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
643 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
644}
645/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
646static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
647 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
648}
649/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
650static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
651 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000652}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000653/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
654/// this size.
655static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
656 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
657 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
658 if (sign) {
659 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
660 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
661 } else {
662 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
663 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
664 }
665
666 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
667
668 if (sign) {
669 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
670 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
671 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
672 } else
673 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
674}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000675
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000676
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000677/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
678/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
679/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
680/// constant and return true.
681static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000682 APInt Demanded) {
683 assert(I && "No instruction?");
684 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
685
686 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
687 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
688 if (!OpC) return false;
689
690 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
691 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
692 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
693 return false;
694
695 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
696 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
697 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
698 return true;
699}
700
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000701// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
702// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
703// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
704// min/max.
705static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000706 const APInt& KnownZero,
707 const APInt& KnownOne,
708 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
709 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
710 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
711 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
712 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
713 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000714 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000715
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000716 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
717 // bit if it is unknown.
718 Min = KnownOne;
719 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
720
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000721 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000722 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
723 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000724 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000725}
726
727// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
728// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
729// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
730// min/max.
731static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000732 const APInt &KnownZero,
733 const APInt &KnownOne,
734 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
735 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000736 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
737 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
738 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
739 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000740 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000741
742 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
743 Min = KnownOne;
744 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
745 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
746}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000747
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000748/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
749/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
750/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
751/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
752/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
753/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
754/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
755/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
756/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
757/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
758/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
759/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
760/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
761/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
762/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
763bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
764 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
765 unsigned Depth) {
766 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
767 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
768 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
769 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
770 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
771 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
772 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
773 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
774 must have same BitWidth");
775 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
776 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
777 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
778 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
779 return false;
780 }
781
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000782 KnownZero.clear();
783 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000784 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
785 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
786 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
787 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
788 return false;
789 }
790 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
791 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
792 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
793 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
794 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
795 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
796 return false;
797 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
798 return false;
799 }
800
801 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
802 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
803
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000804 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
805 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
806 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000807 default:
808 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
809 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000810 case Instruction::And:
811 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
812 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
813 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
814 return true;
815 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
816 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
817
818 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
819 // LHS.
820 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
821 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
822 return true;
823 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
824 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
825
826 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
827 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
828 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
829 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
830 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
831 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
832 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
833 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
834
835 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
836 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
837 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
838
839 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
840 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
841 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
842
843 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
844 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
845 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
846 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
847 break;
848 case Instruction::Or:
849 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
850 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
851 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
852 return true;
853 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
854 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
855 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
856 // LHS.
857 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
858 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
859 return true;
860 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
861 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
862
863 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
864 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
865 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
866 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
867 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
868 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
869 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
870 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
871
872 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
873 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
874 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
875 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
876 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
877 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
878 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
879 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
880
881 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
882 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
883 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
884
885 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
886 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
887 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
888 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
889 break;
890 case Instruction::Xor: {
891 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
892 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
893 return true;
894 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
895 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
896 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
897 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
898 return true;
899 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
900 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
901
902 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
903 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
904 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
905 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
906 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
907 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
908
909 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
910 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
911 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
912 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
913 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
914 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
915
916 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
917 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
918 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
919 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
920 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000921 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000922 I->getName());
923 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
924 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
925 }
926
927 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
928 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
929 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
930 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
931 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
932 // all known
933 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
934 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
935 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000936 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000937 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
938 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
939 }
940 }
941
942 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
943 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
944 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
945 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
946
947 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
948 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
949 break;
950 }
951 case Instruction::Select:
952 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
953 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
954 return true;
955 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
956 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
957 return true;
958 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
959 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
960 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
961 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
962
963 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
964 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
965 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
966 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
967 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
968
969 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
970 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
971 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
972 break;
973 case Instruction::Trunc: {
974 uint32_t truncBf =
975 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +0000976 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
977 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
978 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
979 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
980 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000981 return true;
982 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
983 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
984 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
985 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
986 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
987 break;
988 }
989 case Instruction::BitCast:
990 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
991 return false;
992
993 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
994 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
995 return true;
996 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
997 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
998 break;
999 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1000 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1001 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001002 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001003
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001004 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1005 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1006 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001007 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1008 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001009 return true;
1010 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1011 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1012 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1013 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1014 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1015 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001016 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001017 break;
1018 }
1019 case Instruction::SExt: {
1020 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1021 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001022 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001023
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001024 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001025 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001026
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001027 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001028 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1029 // bit is demanded.
1030 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001031 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001032
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001033 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1034 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1035 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001036 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1037 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001038 return true;
1039 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1040 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1041 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1042 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1043 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1044
1045 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1046 // top bits of the result.
1047
1048 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1049 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001050 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001051 {
1052 // Convert to ZExt cast
1053 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1054 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001055 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001056 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001057 }
1058 break;
1059 }
1060 case Instruction::Add: {
1061 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1062 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1063 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001064 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001065
1066 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1067 // we can do.
1068 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1069 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1070 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1071 if (RHS->isZero())
1072 break;
1073
1074 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1075 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001076 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001077
1078 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1079 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1080 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1081 return true;
1082
1083 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1084 // the constant.
1085 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1086 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1087
1088 // Avoid excess work.
1089 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1090 break;
1091
1092 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1093 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1094 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001095 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001096 I->getName());
1097 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1098 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1099 }
1100
1101 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1102 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1103 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1104 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1105 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1106
1107 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1108 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1109 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001110 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1111 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001112
1113 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1114
1115 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1116 // other, and there is no input carry.
1117 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1118 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1119
1120 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1121 // is no input carry.
1122 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1123 } else {
1124 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1125 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001126 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001127 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1128 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001129 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001130 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1131 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1132 return true;
1133 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1134 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1135 return true;
1136 }
1137 }
1138 break;
1139 }
1140 case Instruction::Sub:
1141 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1142 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001143 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001144 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1145 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001146 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001147 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001148 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1149 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1150 return true;
1151 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1152 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1153 return true;
1154 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001155 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1156 // the known zeros and ones.
1157 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001158 break;
1159 case Instruction::Shl:
1160 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001161 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001162 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1163 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001164 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1165 return true;
1166 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1167 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1168 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1169 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1170 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001171 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001172 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001173 }
1174 break;
1175 case Instruction::LShr:
1176 // For a logical shift right
1177 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001178 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001179
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001180 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001181 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1182 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001183 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1184 return true;
1185 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1186 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001187 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1188 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001189 if (ShiftAmt) {
1190 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001191 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001192 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1193 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001194 }
1195 break;
1196 case Instruction::AShr:
1197 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1198 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1199 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1200 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1201 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1202 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001203 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001204 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1205 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1206 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1207 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001208
1209 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1210 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1211 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1212 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001213
1214 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001215 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001216
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001217 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001218 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001219 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1220 // demanded.
1221 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1222 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001223 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001224 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001225 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1226 return true;
1227 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1228 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1229 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001230 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001231 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1232 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1233
1234 // Handle the sign bits.
1235 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1236 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1237 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1238
1239 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1240 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001241 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001242 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1243 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001244 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001245 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1246 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1247 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1248 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1249 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1250 }
1251 }
1252 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001253 case Instruction::SRem:
1254 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1255 APInt RA = Rem->getValue();
1256 if (RA.isPowerOf2() || (-RA).isPowerOf2()) {
Dan Gohman23e1df82008-05-06 00:51:48 +00001257 APInt LowBits = RA.isStrictlyPositive() ? (RA - 1) : ~RA;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001258 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
1259 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1260 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1261 return true;
1262
1263 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1264 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
1265 else if (LHSKnownOne[BitWidth-1])
1266 LHSKnownOne |= ~LowBits;
1267
1268 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
1269 KnownOne |= LHSKnownOne & DemandedMask;
1270
1271 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1272 }
1273 }
1274 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001275 case Instruction::URem: {
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001276 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1277 APInt RA = Rem->getValue();
Dan Gohman23e1df82008-05-06 00:51:48 +00001278 if (RA.isPowerOf2()) {
1279 APInt LowBits = (RA - 1);
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001280 APInt Mask2 = LowBits & DemandedMask;
1281 KnownZero |= ~LowBits & DemandedMask;
1282 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1283 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1))
1284 return true;
1285
1286 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001287 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001288 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001289 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001290
1291 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1292 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001293 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), AllOnes,
1294 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1295 return true;
1296
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001297 uint32_t Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001298 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001299 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1300 return true;
1301
1302 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1303 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1304 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001305 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001306 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001307 case Instruction::Call:
1308 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1309 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1310 default: break;
1311 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1312 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1313 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1314 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1315 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1316
1317 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1318 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1319 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1320 NLZ &= ~7;
1321 NTZ &= ~7;
1322 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1323 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1324 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1325 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1326
1327 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1328 // the right place.
1329 Instruction *NewVal;
1330 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1331 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
1332 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
1333 else
1334 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
1335 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
1336 NewVal->takeName(I);
1337 InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
1338 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1339 }
1340
1341 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1342 break;
1343 }
1344 }
1345 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001346 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001347 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001348 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001349
1350 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1351 // constant.
1352 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1353 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1354 return false;
1355}
1356
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001357
1358/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1359/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1360/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1361/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1362///
1363/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1364/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1365/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1366Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1367 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1368 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001369 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001370 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1371 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
1372 assert(DemandedElts != EltMask && (DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 &&
1373 "Invalid DemandedElts!");
1374
1375 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1376 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1377 UndefElts = EltMask;
1378 return 0;
1379 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1380 UndefElts = EltMask;
1381 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1382 }
1383
1384 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001385 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1386 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001387 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1388
1389 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1390 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1391 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1392 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1393 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1394 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1395 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1396 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1397 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1398 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1399 }
1400
1401 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001402 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001403 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1404 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001405 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001406 // set to undef.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001407 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001408 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1409 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1410 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1411 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1412 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1413 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001414 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001415 }
1416
1417 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
1418 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
1419 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1420 return false;
1421 }
1422 return false;
1423 } else if (Depth == 10) { // Limit search depth.
1424 return false;
1425 }
1426
1427 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1428 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1429
1430 bool MadeChange = false;
1431 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1432 Value *TmpV;
1433 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1434 default: break;
1435
1436 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1437 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1438 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001439 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001440 if (Idx == 0) {
1441 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1442 // which elt is getting updated.
1443 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1444 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1445 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1446 break;
1447 }
1448
1449 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1450 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001451 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001452 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1453 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1454
1455 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1456 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1457 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1458 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1459 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1460 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1461
1462 // The inserted element is defined.
1463 UndefElts |= 1ULL << IdxNo;
1464 break;
1465 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001466 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001467 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001468 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1469 if (!VTy) break;
1470 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1471 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1472 unsigned Ratio;
1473
1474 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001475 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001476 // elements as are demanded of us.
1477 Ratio = 1;
1478 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1479 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1480 // Untested so far.
1481 break;
1482
1483 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1484 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1485 // elements are live.
1486 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1487 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1488 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1489 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1490 }
1491 } else {
1492 // Untested so far.
1493 break;
1494
1495 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1496 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1497 // live.
1498 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1499 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1500 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1501 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1502 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001503
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001504 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1505 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1506 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1507 if (TmpV) {
1508 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1509 MadeChange = true;
1510 }
1511
1512 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1513 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1514 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1515 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1516 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1517 // undef.
1518 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1519 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1520 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1521 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1522 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1523 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1524 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1525 // elements are undef.
1526 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1527 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1528 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1529 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1530 }
1531 break;
1532 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001533 case Instruction::And:
1534 case Instruction::Or:
1535 case Instruction::Xor:
1536 case Instruction::Add:
1537 case Instruction::Sub:
1538 case Instruction::Mul:
1539 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1540 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1541 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1542 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1543 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1544 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1545 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1546
1547 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1548 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1549 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1550 break;
1551
1552 case Instruction::Call: {
1553 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1554 if (!II) break;
1555 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1556 default: break;
1557
1558 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1559 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1560 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1561 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1562 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1563 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1564 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1565 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1566 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1567 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1568 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1569 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1570 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1571 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1572 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1573 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1574
1575 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1576 // scalarize it now.
1577 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1578 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1579 default: break;
1580 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1581 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1582 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1583 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1584 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1585 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1586 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1587 // Extract the element as scalars.
1588 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1589 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1590
1591 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1592 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1593 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1594 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001595 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001596 II->getName()), *II);
1597 break;
1598 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1599 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001600 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001601 II->getName()), *II);
1602 break;
1603 }
1604
1605 Instruction *New =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001606 InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1607 II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001608 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1609 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1610 return New;
1611 }
1612 }
1613
1614 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1615 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1616 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1617 break;
1618 }
1619 break;
1620 }
1621 }
1622 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1623}
1624
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001625
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001626/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1627/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1628/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1629/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1630/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1631/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1632/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1633///
1634template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman76d402b2008-05-20 01:14:05 +00001635static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001636 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1637 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1638
1639 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1640 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1641 return F.apply(Root);
1642
1643 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1644 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001645 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001646 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1647 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1648
1649 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1650 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1651 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1652 ShouldApply = true;
1653 }
1654
1655 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1656 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1657 if (ShouldApply) {
1658 BasicBlock *BB = Root.getParent();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001659
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001660 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1661 // and perform the reassociation.
1662 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1663
1664 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1665 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1666
1667 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1668 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001669 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001670 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1671 return 0;
1672 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001673 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001674 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001675 TmpLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(TmpLHSI);
1676 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
1677 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, TmpLHSI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
1678 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001679
1680 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1681 // get to LHSI.
1682 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1683 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001684 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1685 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
1686 NextLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(NextLHSI);
1687 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, NextLHSI);
1688 ARI = NextLHSI;
1689
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001690 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1691 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1692 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1693 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1694 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001695
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001696 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1697 // the transformation...
1698 return F.apply(Root);
1699 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001700
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001701 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1702 }
1703 return 0;
1704}
1705
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001706namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001707
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001708// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001709struct AddRHS {
1710 Value *RHS;
1711 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1712 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1713 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001714 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
1715 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001716 }
1717};
1718
1719// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1720// iff C1&C2 == 0
1721struct AddMaskingAnd {
1722 Constant *C2;
1723 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1724 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001725 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001726 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001727 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001728 }
1729 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001730 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001731 }
1732};
1733
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001734}
1735
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001736static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001737 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001738 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001739 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001740 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001741
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001742 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001743 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001744 }
1745
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001746 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001747 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1748 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001749
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001750 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1751 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001752 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1753 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001754 }
1755
1756 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1757 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1758 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1759 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001760 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001761 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001762 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001763 New = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001764 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001765 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001766 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001767 abort();
1768 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001769 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1770}
1771
1772// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1773// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1774// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1775// not have a second operand.
1776static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1777 InstCombiner *IC) {
1778 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1779 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1780 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1781 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1782
1783 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001784 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001785 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001786
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001787 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1788 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1789
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001790 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1791 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001792 }
1793 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001794}
1795
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001796
1797/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1798/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1799/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1800Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1801 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001802 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001803 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001804
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001805 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1806 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001807 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001808 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1809 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1810 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1811 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001812 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001813 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1814
1815 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1816 // loop.
1817 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1818 return 0;
1819 }
1820
1821 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1822 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1823 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1824 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1825 if (NonConstBB) {
1826 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1827 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1828 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001829
1830 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001831 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001832 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001833 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001834 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001835
1836 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1837 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1838 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001839 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001840 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001841 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001842 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1843 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1844 else
1845 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001846 } else {
1847 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1848 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001849 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001850 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1851 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001852 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001853 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001854 CI->getPredicate(),
1855 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1856 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001857 else
1858 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1859
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001860 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001861 }
1862 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001863 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001864 } else {
1865 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1866 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001867 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001868 Value *InV;
1869 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001870 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001871 } else {
1872 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001873 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001874 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1875 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001876 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001877 }
1878 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001879 }
1880 }
1881 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1882}
1883
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001884
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00001885/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
1886/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
1887/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
1888/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
1889bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
1890 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
1891 // ones.
1892
1893 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
1894 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
1895 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
1896 // sign extend fine.
1897 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
1898 return true;
1899
1900
1901 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
1902 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
1903 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
1904 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
1905
1906 // TODO: Implement.
1907
1908 return false;
1909}
1910
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001911
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001912Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001913 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001914 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001915
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001916 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001917 // X + undef -> undef
1918 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1919 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1920
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001921 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001922 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001923 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1924 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001925 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00001926 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
1927 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001928 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001929 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001930
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001931 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001932 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001933 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001934 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001935 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001936 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001937
1938 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1939 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001940 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
1941 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
1942 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
1943 KnownZero, KnownOne))
1944 return &I;
1945 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001946 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001947
1948 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
1949 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1950 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001951
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001952 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
1953 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00001954 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
1955 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001956 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001957 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001958
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001959 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001960 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
1961 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001962 do {
1963 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001964 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
1965 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001966 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
1967 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001968 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00001969 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
1970 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001971 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001972 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001973 }
1974 }
1975 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001976 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
1977 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
1978 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001979
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001980 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00001981 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
1982 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
1983 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001984 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
1985 switch (Size) {
1986 default: break;
1987 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
1988 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
1989 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
1990 }
1991 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00001992 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001993 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001994 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001995 }
1996 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001997 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001998
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00001999 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2000 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2001
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002002 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002003 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002004 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002005
2006 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2007 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2008 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2009 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2010 }
2011 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2012 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2013 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2014 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2015 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002016 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002017
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002018 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002019 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
2020 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002021 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
2022 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002023 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002024 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002025 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002026 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002027 }
2028
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002029 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002030 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002031
2032 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002033 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2034 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002035 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002036
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002037
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002038 ConstantInt *C2;
2039 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2040 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002041 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002042
2043 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2044 ConstantInt *C1;
2045 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002046 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002047 }
2048
2049 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002050 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002051 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002052
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002053 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002054 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2055 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002056
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002057
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002058 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002059 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002060 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2061 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002062
2063 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2064 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2065 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2066 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2067 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2068 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2069 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2070 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2071 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2072 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2073
2074 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002075 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002076 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002077 }
2078 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002079
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002080 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002081 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002082 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
2083 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2084 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
2085 if (W != Y) {
2086 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002087 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002088 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002089 std::swap(W, X);
2090 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002091 std::swap(Y, Z);
2092 std::swap(W, X);
2093 }
2094 }
2095
2096 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002097 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002098 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002099 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002100 }
2101 }
2102 }
2103
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002104 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002105 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002106 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002107 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002108
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002109 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2110 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002111 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002112 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2113 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2114 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002115 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002116
2117 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002118 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002119
2120 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002121 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002122
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002123 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2124 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002125 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002126 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002127 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002128 }
2129 }
2130 }
2131
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002132 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2133 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002134 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002135 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002136 }
2137
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002138 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002139 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) --> intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002140 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002141 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2142 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002143 if (!CI) {
2144 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2145 Other = LHS;
2146 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002147 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002148 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2149 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002150 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002151 unsigned AS =
2152 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00002153 Value *I2 = InsertBitCastBefore(CI->getOperand(0),
2154 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002155 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(GetElementPtrInst::Create(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002156 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002157 }
2158 }
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002159
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002160 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002161 {
2162 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
2163 Value *Other = RHS;
2164 if (!SI) {
2165 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
2166 Other = LHS;
2167 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002168 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002169 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2170 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002171 Value *A, *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002172
2173 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2174 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002175 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) && match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2176 A == Other) // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002177 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002178 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) && match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2179 A == Other) // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002180 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002181 }
2182 }
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002183
2184 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2185 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2186 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2187 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002188
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002189 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2190 // integer add followed by a sext.
2191 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2192 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2193 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2194 Constant *CI =
2195 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2196 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2197 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
2198 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2199 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2200 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2201 CI, "addconv");
2202 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2203 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2204 }
2205 }
2206
2207 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2208 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2209 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2210 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2211 // integer add will not overflow.
2212 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2213 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2214 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2215 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2216 // Insert the new integer add.
2217 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2218 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2219 "addconv");
2220 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2221 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2222 }
2223 }
2224 }
2225
2226 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2227 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2228 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2229 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2230 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2231 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2232 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2233 // instcombined.
2234 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2235 Constant *CI =
2236 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2237 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2238 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
2239 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2240 // Insert the new integer add.
2241 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2242 CI, "addconv");
2243 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2244 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2245 }
2246 }
2247
2248 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2249 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2250 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2251 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2252 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2253 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2254 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2255 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2256 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2257 // Insert the new integer add.
2258 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2259 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2260 "addconv");
2261 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2262 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2263 }
2264 }
2265 }
2266
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002267 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002268}
2269
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002270Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002271 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002272
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002273 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
2274 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002275
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002276 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002277 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002278 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002279
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002280 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2281 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2282 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2283 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2284
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002285 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2286 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002287 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002288 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002289
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002290 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002291 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002292 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002293 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002294
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002295 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2296 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002297 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002298 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002299 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002300 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002301 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002302 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002303 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002304 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002305 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002306 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002307 }
2308 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002309 }
2310 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2311 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2312 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002313 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002314 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002315 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002316 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002317 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002318 }
2319 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002320 }
2321 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002322 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002323
2324 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2325 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002326 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002327 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002328
2329 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2330 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2331 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002332 }
2333
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002334 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2335 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2336
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002337 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2338 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002339 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002340 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002341 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002342 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002343 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002344 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2345 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2346 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002347 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002348 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2349 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002350 }
2351
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002352 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002353 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2354 // is not used by anyone else...
2355 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002356 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002357 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002358 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2359 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2360 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2361 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002362
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002363 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002364 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002365 }
2366
2367 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2368 //
2369 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2370 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2371 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2372
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002373 Value *NewNot =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002374 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
2375 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002376 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002377
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002378 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002379 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002380 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002381 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002382 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002383 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002384 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2385
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002386 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002387 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002388 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002389 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002390 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002391 }
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002392
2393 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2394 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2395 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2396 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2397 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2398 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002399 return BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002400 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002401 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002402 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002403 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002404 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002405
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002406 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002407 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002408 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002409 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2410 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2411 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2412 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002413 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2414 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002415 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002416 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002417 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002418
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002419 ConstantInt *C1;
2420 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002421 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002422 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002423
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002424 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2425 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002426 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002427 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002428 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002429}
2430
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002431/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2432/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2433/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2434/// signed.
2435static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2436 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002437 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002438 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2439 TrueIfSigned = true;
2440 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002441 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2442 TrueIfSigned = true;
2443 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002444 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2445 TrueIfSigned = false;
2446 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002447 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2448 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2449 TrueIfSigned = true;
2450 return RHS->getValue() ==
2451 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2452 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2453 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2454 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002455 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002456 default:
2457 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002458 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002459}
2460
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002461Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002462 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002463 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002464
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002465 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2466 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2467
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002468 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002469 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2470 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002471
2472 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002473 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002474 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2475 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002476 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002477 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002478
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002479 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002480 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2481 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2482 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2483 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002484 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002485
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002486 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002487 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002488 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002489 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002490 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002491 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002492 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2493 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002494
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002495 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2496 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00002497 // We need a better interface for long double here.
2498 if (Op1->getType() == Type::FloatTy || Op1->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
2499 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2500 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002501 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002502
2503 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2504 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002505 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002506 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002507 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002508 Op1, "tmp");
2509 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2510 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2511 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002512 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002513
2514 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002515
2516 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2517 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002518 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002519 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002520
2521 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2522 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2523 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002524 }
2525
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002526 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2527 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002528 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002529
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002530 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2531 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2532
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002533 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2534 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2535 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2536 // formed.
2537 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002538 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002539 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002540 BoolCast = CI;
2541 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002542 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002543 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002544 BoolCast = CI;
2545 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002546 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002547 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2548 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002549 bool TIS = false;
2550
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002551 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002552 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2553 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002554 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2555 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002556 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002557 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002558 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002559 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002560 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002561 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002562 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2563 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002564
2565 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2566 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002567 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002568 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2569 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002570 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2571 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2572 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2573 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2574 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002575
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002576 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002577 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002578 }
2579 }
2580 }
2581
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002582 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002583}
2584
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002585/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2586/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2587/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2588/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002589Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002590 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002591
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002592 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2593 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2594 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2595 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2596 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002597 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002598 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002599
2600 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002601 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002602 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002603
Chris Lattner25feae52008-01-28 00:58:18 +00002604 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2605 // This does not apply for fdiv.
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002606 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner25feae52008-01-28 00:58:18 +00002607 // [su]div X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div X, Y. If the div and the select are in
2608 // the same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the
2609 // condition of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same BB).
2610 // If the select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be
2611 // simplified also. Note that div X, Y is just as good as div X, 0 (undef)
2612 if (ConstantInt *ST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002613 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2614 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2615 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002616 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002617 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2618 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2619 else
2620 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
2621 return &I;
2622 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002623
Chris Lattner25feae52008-01-28 00:58:18 +00002624 // Likewise for: [su]div X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div X, Y
2625 if (ConstantInt *ST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002626 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2627 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2628 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002629 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002630 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2631 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2632 else
2633 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2634 return &I;
2635 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002636 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002637
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002638 return 0;
2639}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002640
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002641/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2642/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2643/// division instructions.
2644/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002645Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002646 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2647
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002648 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002649 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2650 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2651 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
2652 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
2653 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
2654 }
2655
2656 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
2657 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2658 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002659
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002660 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2661 return Common;
2662
2663 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2664 // div X, 1 == X
2665 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2666 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2667
2668 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2669 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2670 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2671 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002672 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS, I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
2673 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2674 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002675 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002676 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002677 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002678
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002679 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002680 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2681 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2682 return R;
2683 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2684 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2685 return NV;
2686 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002687 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002688
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002689 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002690 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002691 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2692 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2693
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002694 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
2695 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2696 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2697
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002698 return 0;
2699}
2700
2701Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2702 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2703
2704 // Handle the integer div common cases
2705 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2706 return Common;
2707
2708 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2709 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2710 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2711 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002712 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002713 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002714 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002715 }
2716
2717 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002718 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002719 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2720 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002721 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002722 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002723 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002724 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002725 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002726 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002727 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002728 }
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002729 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002730 }
2731 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002732 }
2733
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002734 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2735 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002736 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002737 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002738 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002739 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002740 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002741 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002742 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002743 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2744 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002745 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002746 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2747 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2748
2749 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2750 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002751 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002752 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2753 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002754
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002755 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002756 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002757 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002758 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002759 return 0;
2760}
2761
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002762Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2763 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2764
2765 // Handle the integer div common cases
2766 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2767 return Common;
2768
2769 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2770 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2771 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002772 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002773
2774 // -X/C -> X/-C
2775 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002776 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002777 }
2778
2779 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2780 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002781 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002782 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002783 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002784 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002785 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002786 }
2787 }
2788
2789 return 0;
2790}
2791
2792Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2793 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2794}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002795
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002796/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2797/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2798/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2799/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2800Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002801 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002802
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002803 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002804 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2805 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2806 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2807
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002808 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
2809 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2810 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002811 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002812 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002813 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2814 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002815
2816 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2817 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2818 // rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> rem X, Y. If the rem and the select are in
2819 // the same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the
2820 // condition of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same
2821 // BB). If the select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be
2822 // simplified also.
2823 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2824 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2825 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2826 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002827 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002828 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2829 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2830 else
2831 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002832 return &I;
2833 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002834 // Likewise for: rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> rem X, Y
2835 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2836 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2837 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2838 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002839 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002840 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2841 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2842 else
2843 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2844 return &I;
2845 }
Chris Lattner11a49f22005-11-05 07:28:37 +00002846 }
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002847
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002848 return 0;
2849}
2850
2851/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2852/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2853/// remainder instructions.
2854/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2855Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2856 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2857
2858 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2859 return common;
2860
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002861 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002862 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2863 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2864 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2865
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002866 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2867 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2868
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002869 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2870 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2871 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2872 return R;
2873 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2874 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2875 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002876 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00002877
2878 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
2879 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
2880 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2881 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2882 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2883 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002884 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002885 }
2886
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002887 return 0;
2888}
2889
2890Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2891 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2892
2893 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2894 return common;
2895
2896 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2897 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2898 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2899 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2900 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002901 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002902 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002903 }
2904
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002905 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002906 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2907 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2908 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002909 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002910 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002911 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002912 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002913 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002914 }
2915 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002916 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002917
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002918 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
2919 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2920 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2921 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2922 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2923 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002924 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
2925 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002926 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002927 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002928 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002929 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002930 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002931 }
2932 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002933 }
2934
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002935 return 0;
2936}
2937
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002938Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2939 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2940
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002941 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002942 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2943 return common;
2944
2945 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
2946 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) ||
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002947 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002948 // X % -Y -> X % Y
2949 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
2950 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
2951 return &I;
2952 }
2953
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002954 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002955 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002956 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
2957 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
2958 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2959 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002960 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002961 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002962 }
2963
2964 return 0;
2965}
2966
2967Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002968 return commonRemTransforms(I);
2969}
2970
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002971// isMaxValueMinusOne - return true if this is Max-1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002972static bool isMaxValueMinusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Reid Spencer3a2a9fb2007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002973 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002974 if (!isSigned)
2975 return C->getValue() == APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits) - 1;
2976 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(TypeBits)-1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002977}
2978
2979// isMinValuePlusOne - return true if this is Min+1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002980static bool isMinValuePlusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002981 if (!isSigned)
2982 return C->getValue() == 1; // unsigned
2983
2984 // Calculate 1111111111000000000000
2985 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2986 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMinValue(TypeBits)+1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002987}
2988
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002989// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
2990// constant.
2991static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00002992 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002993}
2994
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002995// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
2996// This is the same as lowones(~X).
2997static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00002998 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002999}
3000
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003001/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003002/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3003///
3004/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3005///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003006/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3007/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003008///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003009/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3010/// 0 A > B
3011/// 1 A == B
3012/// 2 A < B
3013///
3014/// <=> Value Definition
3015/// 000 0 Always false
3016/// 001 1 A > B
3017/// 010 2 A == B
3018/// 011 3 A >= B
3019/// 100 4 A < B
3020/// 101 5 A != B
3021/// 110 6 A <= B
3022/// 111 7 Always true
3023///
3024static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3025 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003026 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003027 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3028 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3029 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3030 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3031 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3032 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3033 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3034 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3035 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3036 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003037 // True -> 7
3038 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003039 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003040 return 0;
3041 }
3042}
3043
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003044/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3045/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003046/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003047/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
3048static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3049 switch (code) {
3050 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003051 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003052 case 1:
3053 if (sign)
3054 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
3055 else
3056 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3057 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
3058 case 3:
3059 if (sign)
3060 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
3061 else
3062 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3063 case 4:
3064 if (sign)
3065 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
3066 else
3067 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3068 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
3069 case 6:
3070 if (sign)
3071 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
3072 else
3073 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003074 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003075 }
3076}
3077
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003078static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3079 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
3080 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
3081 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
3082 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
3083 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
3084}
3085
3086namespace {
3087// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3088struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003089 InstCombiner &IC;
3090 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003091 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3092 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3093 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3094 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003095 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003096 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3097 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003098 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3099 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003100 return false;
3101 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003102 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3103 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3104 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3105 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3106 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003107 }
3108
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003109 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003110 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003111 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003112 unsigned Code;
3113 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3114 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3115 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3116 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00003117 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003118 }
3119
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003120 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3121 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3122
3123 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003124 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3125 return I;
3126 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3127 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3128 }
3129};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003130} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003131
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003132// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3133// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003134// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003135Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003136 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3137 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003138 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3139 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003140 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003141 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003142 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003143
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003144 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3145 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003146 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003147 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003148 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003149 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003150 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003151 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003152 }
3153 break;
3154 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003155 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3156 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003157
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003158 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3159 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003160 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003161 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003162 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003163 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003164 }
3165 break;
3166 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003167 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003168 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3169 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3170 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003171 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003172
3173 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003174 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003175 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3176 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3177 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003178 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003179
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003180 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3181 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3182 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3183 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3184 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3185 // no effect.
3186 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3187 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3188 return &TheAnd;
3189 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003190 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003191 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003192 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003193 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003194 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003195 }
3196 }
3197 }
3198 }
3199 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003200
3201 case Instruction::Shl: {
3202 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3203 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3204 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003205 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003206 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003207 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3208 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003209
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003210 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3211 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003212 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3213 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003214 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3215 return &TheAnd;
3216 }
3217 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003218 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003219 case Instruction::LShr:
3220 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003221 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3222 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3223 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3224 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003225 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003226 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003227 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3228 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003229
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003230 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3231 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003232 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3233 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3234 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3235 return &TheAnd;
3236 }
3237 break;
3238 }
3239 case Instruction::AShr:
3240 // Signed shr.
3241 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3242 // with an and.
3243 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003244 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003245 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003246 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3247 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003248 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003249 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003250 // Make the argument unsigned.
3251 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003252 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003253 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003254 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003255 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003256 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003257 }
3258 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003259 }
3260 return 0;
3261}
3262
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003263
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003264/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3265/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003266/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3267/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003268/// insert new instructions.
3269Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003270 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3271 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003272 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003273 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003274 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003275
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003276 if (Inside) {
3277 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003278 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003279
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003280 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003281 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003282 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003283 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3284 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3285 }
3286
3287 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3288 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003289 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003290 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003291 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3292 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003293 }
3294
3295 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003296 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003297
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003298 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003299 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003300 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003301 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3302 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3303 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3304 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003305
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003306 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3307 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3308 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003309 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003310 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003311 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3312 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003313}
3314
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003315// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3316// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3317// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3318// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003319static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003320 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003321 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3322 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003323
3324 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003325 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003326 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003327 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003328 return true;
3329}
3330
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003331/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3332/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3333/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003334///
3335/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3336/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3337/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3338///
3339/// return (A +/- B).
3340///
3341Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003342 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003343 Instruction &I) {
3344 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3345 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3346 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3347
3348 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3349
3350 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3351 default: return 0;
3352 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003353 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003354 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003355 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3356 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3357 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003358 break;
3359
3360 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3361 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3362 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003363 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003364 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003365 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003366 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003367 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003368 break;
3369 }
3370 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003371 return 0;
3372 case Instruction::Or:
3373 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003374 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003375 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3376 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003377 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003378 break;
3379 return 0;
3380 }
3381
3382 Instruction *New;
3383 if (isSub)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003384 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003385 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003386 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003387 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3388}
3389
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003390Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003391 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003392 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003393
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003394 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3395 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3396
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003397 // and X, X = X
3398 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003399 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003400
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003401 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003402 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003403 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003404 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3405 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3406 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003407 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003408 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003409 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003410 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003411 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003412 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003413 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3414 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003415 }
3416 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003417
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003418 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003419 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3420 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003421
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003422 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003423 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003424 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003425 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3426 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3427 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3428 case Instruction::Xor:
3429 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003430 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3431 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3432 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3433 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003434 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003435 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3436 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003437 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003438 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003439 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003440 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003441 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3442 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003443 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003444 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3445 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003446 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003447 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3448 }
3449 }
3450
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003451 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003452 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003453 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3454 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3455 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3456 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003457 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003458 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003459 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003460 break;
3461
3462 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003463 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3464 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3465 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3466 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003467 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003468 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003469 }
3470
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003471 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003472 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003473 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003474 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003475 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3476 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3477 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3478 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003479 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003480 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003481 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003482 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3483 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003484 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3485 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3486 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003487 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003488 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3489 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003490 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003491 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003492 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003493 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003494 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003495 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3496 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3497 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003498 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003499 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3500 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3501 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003502 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003503 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003504 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003505
3506 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3507 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003508 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003509 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003510 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3511 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3512 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003513 }
3514
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003515 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3516 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003517
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003518 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3519 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3520
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003521 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003522 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003523 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003524 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003525 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003526 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003527 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003528
3529 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003530 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3531 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003532 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3533 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003534
3535 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3536 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3537 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003538 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003539 }
3540 }
3541
3542 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003543 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3544 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003545
3546 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3547 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3548 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003549 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003550 }
3551 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003552
3553 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3554 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3555 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3556 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3557 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3558 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3559 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3560 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3561 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3562 }
3563 }
3564 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3565 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3566 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3567 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3568 std::swap(A, B);
3569 }
3570 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003571 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(B, "tmp");
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003572 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003573 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003574 }
3575 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003576 }
3577
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003578 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3579 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3580 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003581 return R;
3582
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003583 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3584 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003585 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3586 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3587 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3588 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3589 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3590 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3591 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3592 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattnereec8b9a2007-11-22 23:47:13 +00003593 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3594
3595 // Don't try to fold ICMP_SLT + ICMP_ULT.
3596 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) || ICmpInst::isEquality(RHSCC) ||
3597 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ==
3598 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC))) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003599 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneree2b7a42008-01-13 20:59:02 +00003600 ICmpInst::Predicate GT;
3601 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3602 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3603 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
3604 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
3605 else
3606 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3607
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003608 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3609 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003610 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003611 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3612 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3613 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3614 }
3615
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003616 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003617 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3618 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003619 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3620 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3621 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003622 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3623
3624 switch (LHSCC) {
3625 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003626 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003627 switch (RHSCC) {
3628 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003629 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3630 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3631 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003632 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003633 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3634 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3635 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003636 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3637 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003638 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003639 switch (RHSCC) {
3640 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003641 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3642 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3643 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3644 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3645 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3646 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3647 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3648 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3649 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3650 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3651 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003652 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003653 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3654 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003655 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003656 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003657 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3658 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattner424db022007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003659 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3660 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003661 }
3662 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3663 }
3664 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003665 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003666 switch (RHSCC) {
3667 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003668 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3669 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003670 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003671 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3672 break;
3673 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3674 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003675 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003676 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3677 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003678 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003679 break;
3680 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003681 switch (RHSCC) {
3682 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003683 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3684 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003685 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003686 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3687 break;
3688 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3689 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003690 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003691 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3692 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003693 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003694 break;
3695 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3696 switch (RHSCC) {
3697 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3698 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X > 13
3699 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3700 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3701 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3702 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3703 break;
3704 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3705 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3706 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3707 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3708 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3709 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3710 true, I);
3711 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3712 break;
3713 }
3714 break;
3715 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3716 switch (RHSCC) {
3717 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattnera7d1ab02007-11-16 06:04:17 +00003718 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003719 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3720 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3721 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3722 break;
3723 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3724 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3725 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3726 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3727 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3728 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3729 true, I);
3730 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3731 break;
3732 }
3733 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003734 }
3735 }
3736 }
3737
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003738 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003739 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3740 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3741 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3742 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003743 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003744 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003745 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3746 I.getType(), TD) &&
3747 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3748 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003749 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003750 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3751 I.getName());
3752 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003753 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003754 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003755 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003756
3757 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003758 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3759 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3760 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003761 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3762 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3763 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003764 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003765 SI1->getOperand(0),
3766 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003767 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003768 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003769 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003770 }
3771
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003772 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
3773 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
3774 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3775 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
3776 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD)
3777 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3778 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3779 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3780 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00003781 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003782 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3783 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
3784 RHS->getOperand(0));
3785 }
3786 }
3787 }
3788
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003789 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003790}
3791
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003792/// CollectBSwapParts - Look to see if the specified value defines a single byte
3793/// in the result. If it does, and if the specified byte hasn't been filled in
3794/// yet, fill it in and return false.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003795static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003796 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
3797 if (I == 0) return true;
3798
3799 // If this is an or instruction, it is an inner node of the bswap.
3800 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or)
3801 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3802 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), ByteValues);
3803
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003804 uint32_t BitWidth = I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003805 // If this is a shift by a constant int, and it is "24", then its operand
3806 // defines a byte. We only handle unsigned types here.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003807 if (I->isShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003808 // Not shifting the entire input by N-1 bytes?
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003809 if (cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) !=
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003810 8*(ByteValues.size()-1))
3811 return true;
3812
3813 unsigned DestNo;
3814 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3815 // X << 24 defines the top byte with the lowest of the input bytes.
3816 DestNo = ByteValues.size()-1;
3817 } else {
3818 // X >>u 24 defines the low byte with the highest of the input bytes.
3819 DestNo = 0;
3820 }
3821
3822 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3823 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3824 if (ByteValues[DestNo] && ByteValues[DestNo] != I->getOperand(0))
3825 return true;
3826 ByteValues[DestNo] = I->getOperand(0);
3827 return false;
3828 }
3829
3830 // Otherwise, we can only handle and(shift X, imm), imm). Bail out of if we
3831 // don't have this.
3832 Value *Shift = 0, *ShiftLHS = 0;
3833 ConstantInt *AndAmt = 0, *ShiftAmt = 0;
3834 if (!match(I, m_And(m_Value(Shift), m_ConstantInt(AndAmt))) ||
3835 !match(Shift, m_Shift(m_Value(ShiftLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
3836 return true;
3837 Instruction *SI = cast<Instruction>(Shift);
3838
3839 // Make sure that the shift amount is by a multiple of 8 and isn't too big.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003840 if (ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) & 7 ||
3841 ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) > 8*ByteValues.size())
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003842 return true;
3843
3844 // Turn 0xFF -> 0, 0xFF00 -> 1, 0xFF0000 -> 2, etc.
3845 unsigned DestByte;
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003846 if (AndAmt->getValue().getActiveBits() > 64)
3847 return true;
3848 uint64_t AndAmtVal = AndAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003849 for (DestByte = 0; DestByte != ByteValues.size(); ++DestByte)
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003850 if (AndAmtVal == uint64_t(0xFF) << 8*DestByte)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003851 break;
3852 // Unknown mask for bswap.
3853 if (DestByte == ByteValues.size()) return true;
3854
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003855 unsigned ShiftBytes = ShiftAmt->getZExtValue()/8;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003856 unsigned SrcByte;
3857 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3858 SrcByte = DestByte - ShiftBytes;
3859 else
3860 SrcByte = DestByte + ShiftBytes;
3861
3862 // If the SrcByte isn't a bswapped value from the DestByte, reject it.
3863 if (SrcByte != ByteValues.size()-DestByte-1)
3864 return true;
3865
3866 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3867 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3868 if (ByteValues[DestByte] && ByteValues[DestByte] != SI->getOperand(0))
3869 return true;
3870 ByteValues[DestByte] = SI->getOperand(0);
3871 return false;
3872}
3873
3874/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
3875/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
3876Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003877 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
3878 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16)
3879 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003880
3881 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
3882 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003883 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003884 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003885
3886 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
3887 if (CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3888 CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(1), ByteValues))
3889 return 0;
3890
3891 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
3892 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
3893 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
3894
3895 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
3896 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
3897 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
3898 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003899 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003900 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003901 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003902 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003903}
3904
3905
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003906Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003907 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003908 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003909
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003910 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003911 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003912
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003913 // or X, X = X
3914 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003915 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003916
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003917 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3918 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003919 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3920 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3921 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3922 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3923 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3924 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003925 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3926 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
3927 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3928 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
3929 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003930 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003931
3932
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003933
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003934 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003935 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003936 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003937 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
3938 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003939 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003940 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003941 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003942 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003943 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003944 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003945
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003946 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
3947 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003948 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003949 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003950 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003951 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003952 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003953 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003954
3955 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3956 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003957 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003958 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003959 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3960 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3961 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003962 }
3963
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003964 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
3965 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003966
3967 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3968 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
3969 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3970 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3971 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
3972 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3973
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003974 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
3975 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003976 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003977 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
3978 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
3979 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003980 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
3981 return BSwap;
3982 }
3983
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003984 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3985 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003986 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003987 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003988 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3989 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003990 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003991 }
3992
3993 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3994 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003995 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003996 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003997 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3998 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003999 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004000 }
4001
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004002 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004003 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004004 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4005 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004006 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4007 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4008 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4009 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4010 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4011 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4012 // replace with V+N.
4013 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4014 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
4015 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4016 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4017 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4018 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4019 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4020 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4021 }
4022 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4023 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
4024 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4025 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4026 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4027 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4028 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4029 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4030 }
4031 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004032 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004033 }
4034
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004035 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4036 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004037 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4038 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4039 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4040 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4041 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4042 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4043 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4044 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4045 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4046
4047 if (V1) {
4048 Value *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004049 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4050 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004051 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004052 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004053 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004054
4055 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004056 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4057 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4058 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004059 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4060 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4061 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004062 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004063 SI1->getOperand(0),
4064 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004065 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004066 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004067 }
4068 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004069
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004070 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
4071 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004072 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004073 } else {
4074 A = 0;
4075 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004076 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004077 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
4078 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004079 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004080
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004081 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004082 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004083 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004084 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004085 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004086 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004087 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004088
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004089 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4090 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4091 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004092 return R;
4093
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004094 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
4095 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004096 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4097 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
4098 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
4099 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
4100 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
4101 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4102 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4103 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004104 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
4105 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4106 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004107 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004108 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004109 bool NeedsSwap;
4110 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004111 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004112 else
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004113 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004114
4115 if (NeedsSwap) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004116 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4117 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4118 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4119 }
4120
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004121 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004122 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4123 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004124 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4125 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004126 // equal.
4127 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4128
4129 switch (LHSCC) {
4130 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004131 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004132 switch (RHSCC) {
4133 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004134 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004135 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4136 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004137 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004138 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
4139 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004140 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004141 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004142 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004143 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4144 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4145 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner240d6f42005-04-19 06:04:18 +00004146 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004147 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4148 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4149 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004150 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4151 }
4152 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004153 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004154 switch (RHSCC) {
4155 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004156 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4157 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4158 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004159 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004160 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4161 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4162 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004163 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004164 }
4165 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004166 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004167 switch (RHSCC) {
4168 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004169 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004170 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004171 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004172 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4173 // this can cause overflow.
4174 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4175 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004176 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
4177 false, I);
4178 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4179 break;
4180 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4181 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004182 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004183 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4184 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004185 }
4186 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004187 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004188 switch (RHSCC) {
4189 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004190 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4191 break;
4192 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004193 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4194 // this can cause overflow.
4195 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4196 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004197 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4198 false, I);
4199 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4200 break;
4201 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4202 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4203 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4204 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4205 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004206 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004207 break;
4208 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4209 switch (RHSCC) {
4210 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4211 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4212 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4213 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4214 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4215 break;
4216 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4217 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004218 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004219 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4220 break;
4221 }
4222 break;
4223 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4224 switch (RHSCC) {
4225 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4226 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4227 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4228 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4229 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4230 break;
4231 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4232 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004233 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004234 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4235 break;
4236 }
4237 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004238 }
4239 }
4240 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004241
4242 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004243 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004244 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004245 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004246 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4247 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4248 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4249 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4250 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4251 // generated.
4252 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4253 I.getType(), TD) &&
4254 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4255 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004256 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004257 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4258 I.getName());
4259 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004260 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004261 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004262 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004263 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004264 }
4265
4266
4267 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4268 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4269 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4270 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Chris Lattner5ebd9362008-02-29 06:09:11 +00004271 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4272 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004273 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4274 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4275 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4276 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004277 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004278 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4279
4280 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4281 // rest.
4282 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4283 RHS->getOperand(0));
4284 }
4285 }
4286 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004287
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004288 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004289}
4290
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004291namespace {
4292
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004293// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4294struct XorSelf {
4295 Value *RHS;
4296 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4297 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4298 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4299 return &Xor;
4300 }
4301};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004302
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004303}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004304
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004305Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004306 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004307 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004308
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004309 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
4310 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
4311 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
4312 // idiom (misuse).
4313 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004314 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004315 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004316
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004317 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4318 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004319 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004320 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004321 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004322
4323 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4324 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004325 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4326 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4327 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4328 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4329 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4330 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004331 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4332 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004333 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004334
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004335 // Is this a ~ operation?
4336 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4337 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4338 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4339 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4340 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4341 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4342 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4343 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4344 Instruction *NotY =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004345 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004346 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4347 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4348 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004349 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004350 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004351 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004352 }
4353 }
4354 }
4355 }
4356
4357
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004358 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004359 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4360 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4361 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004362 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4363 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004364
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004365 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4366 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4367 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4368 }
4369
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004370 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
4371 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
4372 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
4373 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
4374 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
4375 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
4376 if (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode, ConstantInt::getTrue(),
4377 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
4378 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
4379 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
4380 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
4381 NewCI->takeName(CI);
4382 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
4383 }
4384 }
4385 }
4386 }
4387 }
4388
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004389 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004390 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004391 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4392 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004393 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4394 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004395 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004396 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004397 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004398
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004399 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004400 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004401 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004402 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004403 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004404 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004405 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004406 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004407 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004408 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004409 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4410 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004411 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004412
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004413 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004414 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4415 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004416 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004417 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4418 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4419 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004420 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004421 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4422 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004423 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004424 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4425 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4426 return &I;
4427 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004428 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004429 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004430 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004431
4432 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4433 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004434 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004435 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004436 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4437 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4438 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004439 }
4440
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004441 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004442 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004443 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004444
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004445 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004446 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004447 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004448
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004449
4450 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4451 if (Op1I) {
4452 Value *A, *B;
4453 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4454 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004455 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004456 I.swapOperands();
4457 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004458 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004459 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004460 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004461 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004462 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4463 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4464 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4465 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4466 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4467 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004468 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004469 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004470 std::swap(A, B);
4471 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004472 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004473 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4474 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4475 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004476 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004477 }
4478
4479 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4480 if (Op0I) {
4481 Value *A, *B;
4482 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4483 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4484 std::swap(A, B);
4485 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4486 Instruction *NotB =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004487 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4488 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004489 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004490 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4491 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4492 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4493 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4494 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4495 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4496 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4497 std::swap(A, B);
4498 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004499 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004500 Instruction *N =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004501 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(A, "tmp"), I);
4502 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004503 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004504 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004505 }
4506
4507 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4508 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4509 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4510 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4511 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4512 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004513 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004514 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4515 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004516 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004517 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4518 }
4519
4520 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4521 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4522 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4523 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4524 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4525 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004526 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004527 }
4528 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4529 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4530 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4531 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004532 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004533 }
4534
4535 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4536 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4537 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4538 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4539 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4540 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4541 if (A == C)
4542 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4543 else if (A == D)
4544 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4545 else if (B == C)
4546 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4547 else if (B == D)
4548 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4549
4550 if (X) {
4551 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004552 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4553 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004554 }
4555 }
4556 }
4557
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004558 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4559 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4560 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004561 return R;
4562
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004563 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004564 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004565 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004566 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4567 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004568 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004569 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004570 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4571 I.getType(), TD) &&
4572 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4573 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004574 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004575 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4576 I.getName());
4577 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004578 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004579 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004580 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004581 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004582
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004583 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004584}
4585
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004586/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4587/// overflowed for this type.
4588static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004589 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004590 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004591
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004592 if (IsSigned)
4593 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4594 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4595 else
4596 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4597 else
4598 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004599}
4600
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004601/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4602/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4603/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4604static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4605 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4606 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004607 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4608 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004609
4610 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004611 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004612 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004613
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00004614 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
4615 ++i, ++GTI) {
4616 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00004617 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004618 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
4619 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
4620
4621 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4622 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4623 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
4624
4625 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
4626 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004627 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004628 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004629 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004630 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
4631 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4632 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004633 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004634
4635 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4636 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
4637 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
4638 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4639 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4640 else {
4641 // Emit an add instruction.
4642 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004643 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004644 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004645 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004646 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004647 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004648 // Convert to correct type.
4649 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
4650 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4651 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
4652 else
4653 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
4654 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4655 }
4656 if (Size != 1) {
4657 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4658 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4659 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4660 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004661 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004662 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
4663 }
4664
4665 // Emit an add instruction.
4666 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
4667 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
4668 cast<Constant>(Result));
4669 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004670 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004671 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004672 }
4673 return Result;
4674}
4675
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004676
4677/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return an value that can be used to compare of
4678/// the *offset* implied by GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we want
4679/// to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can be
4680/// complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be legal
4681/// to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32). This
4682/// later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed to
4683/// generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
4684///
4685/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
4686///
4687static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
4688 InstCombiner &IC) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004689 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4690 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
4691
4692 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
4693 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
4694 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
4695 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
4696 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
4697 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
4698 int64_t Offset = 0;
4699 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4700 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
4701 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
4702 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
4703
4704 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4705 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4706 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
4707 } else {
4708 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4709 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
4710 }
4711 } else {
4712 // Found our variable index.
4713 break;
4714 }
4715 }
4716
4717 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
4718 // evaluate it the general way.
4719 if (i == e) return 0;
4720
4721 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
4722 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
4723 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
4724 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4725
4726 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
4727 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4728 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
4729 if (!CI) return 0;
4730
4731 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
4732 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
4733
4734 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4735 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4736 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
4737 } else {
4738 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4739 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
4740 }
4741 }
4742
4743 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
4744 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
4745 // the index.
4746 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
4747 if (Offset == 0) {
4748 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
4749 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
4750 // computation crosses zero.
4751 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
4752 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
4753 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
4754 return VariableIdx;
4755 }
4756
4757 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
4758 // the pointer size, so get it.
4759 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
4760
4761 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
4762 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
4763
4764 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
4765 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
4766 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
4767 // multiple of the variable scale.
4768 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
4769 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
4770 return 0;
4771
4772 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
4773 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4774 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004775 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004776 true /*SExt*/,
4777 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
4778 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004779 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004780}
4781
4782
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004783/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004784/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004785Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4786 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4787 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004788 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004789
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004790 // Look through bitcasts.
4791 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
4792 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004793
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004794 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4795 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00004796 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004797 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
4798 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
4799 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4800
4801 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
4802 if (Offset == 0)
4803 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00004804 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4805 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004806 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004807 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4808 // compare the base pointer.
4809 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4810 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004811 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004812 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004813 if (IndicesTheSame)
4814 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4815 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4816 IndicesTheSame = false;
4817 break;
4818 }
4819
4820 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
4821 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004822 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
4823 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004824
4825 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
4826 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004827 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004828 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004829
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004830 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
4831 bool AllZeros = true;
4832 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4833 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4834 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4835 AllZeros = false;
4836 break;
4837 }
4838 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004839 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
4840 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004841
4842 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004843 AllZeros = true;
4844 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4845 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4846 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4847 AllZeros = false;
4848 break;
4849 }
4850 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004851 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004852
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004853 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
4854 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
4855 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
4856 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
4857 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4858 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004859 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
4860 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004861 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004862 NumDifferences = 2;
4863 break;
4864 } else {
4865 if (NumDifferences++) break;
4866 DiffOperand = i;
4867 }
4868 }
4869
4870 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
4871 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00004872 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00004873 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00004874
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004875 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004876 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
4877 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004878 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
4879 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004880 }
4881 }
4882
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004883 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004884 // the result to fold to a constant!
4885 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
4886 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
4887 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
4888 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4889 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004890 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004891 }
4892 }
4893 return 0;
4894}
4895
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004896/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
4897///
4898Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
4899 Instruction *LHSI,
4900 Constant *RHSC) {
4901 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
4902 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
4903
4904 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
4905 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00004906 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004907 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
4908
4909 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
4910 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
4911 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
4912 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
4913
4914 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
4915 if (isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI))
4916 ++InputSize;
4917
4918 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
4919 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
4920 return 0;
4921
4922 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
4923 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
4924 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
4925 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
4926
4927 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
4928 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4929 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected predicate!");
4930 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
4931 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ; break;
4932 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
4933 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT; break;
4934 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
4935 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE; break;
4936 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
4937 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT; break;
4938 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
4939 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE; break;
4940 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
4941 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE; break;
4942 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
4943 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4944 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
4945 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4946 }
4947
4948 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
4949
4950 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
4951
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00004952 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004953 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
4954 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
4955
4956 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
4957 // and large values.
4958 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
4959 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
4960 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
4961 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00004962 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
4963 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004964 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4965 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4966 }
4967
4968 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
4969 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
4970 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
4971 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
4972 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00004973 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
4974 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004975 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4976 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4977 }
4978
4979 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] but
4980 // it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by casting the FP
4981 // value to the integer value and back, checking for equality. Don't do this
4982 // for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
4983 Constant *RHSInt = ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
4984 if (!RHS.isZero() &&
4985 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) != RHSC) {
4986 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust
4987 // the compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards
4988 // zero at this point.
4989 switch (Pred) {
4990 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected integer comparison!");
4991 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
4992 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4993 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
4994 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4995 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4996 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
4997 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
4998 if (RHS.isNegative())
4999 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5000 break;
5001 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5002 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5003 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5004 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5005 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5006 break;
5007 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5008 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5009 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5010 if (RHS.isNegative())
5011 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5012 break;
5013 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5014 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5015 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5016 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5017 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5018 break;
5019 }
5020 }
5021
5022 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5023 // comparison.
5024 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
5025}
5026
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005027Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5028 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005029 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005030
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005031 // Fold trivial predicates.
5032 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
5033 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
5034 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
5035 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5036
5037 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5038 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5039 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5040 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
5041 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5042 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5043 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
5044 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5045 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5046 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5047 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
5048 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5049
5050 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5051 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5052 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5053 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5054 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5055 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
5056 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5057 return &I;
5058
5059 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5060 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5061 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5062 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5063 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5064 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
5065 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5066 return &I;
5067 }
5068 }
5069
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005070 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005071 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005072
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005073 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5074 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005075 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5076 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5077 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5078 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
5079 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005080 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5081 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5082 // True if unordered.
5083 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005084 }
5085 }
5086
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005087 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5088 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5089 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005090 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5091 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5092 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5093 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5094 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5095 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005096 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005097 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5098 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5099 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5100 return NV;
5101 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005102 case Instruction::Select:
5103 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5104 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5105 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5106 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5107 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5108 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5109 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5110 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5111 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5112 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5113 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5114 I.getName()), I);
5115 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5116 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5117 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5118 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5119 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5120 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5121 I.getName()), I);
5122 }
5123 }
5124
5125 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005126 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005127 break;
5128 }
5129 }
5130
5131 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5132}
5133
5134Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5135 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5136 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5137 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5138
5139 // icmp X, X
5140 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005141 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005142 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005143
5144 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005145 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005146
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005147 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005148 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005149 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5150 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5151 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005152 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005153 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005154 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005155
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005156 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005157 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005158 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5159 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
5160 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005161 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005162 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005163 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005164 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005165 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005166 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005167
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005168 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5169 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5170 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp gt -> icmp lt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005171 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005172 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5173 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp lt bool A, B -> ~X & Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005174 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005175 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005176 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005177 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005178 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5179 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5180 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ge -> icmp le
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005181 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005182 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5183 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp le bool %A, %B -> ~A | B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005184 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005185 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005186 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005187 }
5188 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005189 }
5190
Chris Lattner2be51ae2004-06-09 04:24:29 +00005191 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
5192 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005193 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005194 Value *A, *B;
5195
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005196 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
5197 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
5198 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5199 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
5200 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00005201 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005202
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005203 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5204 default: break;
5205 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // A <u MIN -> FALSE
5206 if (CI->isMinValue(false))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005207 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005208 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
5209 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0,Op1);
5210 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5211 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00005212 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
5213 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
5214 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
5215 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
5216
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005217 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005218
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005219 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5220 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <s MIN -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005221 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005222 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
5223 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5224 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5225 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5226 break;
5227
5228 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5229 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >u MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005230 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005231 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
5232 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5233 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, false)) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5234 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00005235
5236 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
5237 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
5238 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
5239 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005240 break;
5241
5242 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5243 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >s MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005244 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005245 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
5246 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5247 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, true)) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5248 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5249 break;
5250
5251 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5252 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005253 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005254 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A <=u MIN -> A == MIN
5255 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
5256 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,false)) // A <=u MAX-1 -> A != MAX
5257 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5258 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005259
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005260 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5261 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005262 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005263 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <=s MIN -> A == MIN
5264 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
5265 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,true)) // A <=s MAX-1 -> A != MAX
5266 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5267 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005268
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005269 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5270 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005271 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005272 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >=u MAX -> A == MAX
5273 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
5274 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A >=u MIN-1 -> A != MIN
5275 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5276 break;
5277
5278 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5279 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005280 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005281 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >=s MAX -> A == MAX
5282 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
5283 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A >=s MIN-1 -> A != MIN
5284 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5285 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005286 }
5287
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005288 // If we still have a icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
5289 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. Since the border cases have
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005290 // already been handled above, this requires little checking.
5291 //
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00005292 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005293 default: break;
5294 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5295 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5296 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5297 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5298 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5299 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5300 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5301 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00005302 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005303
5304 // See if we can fold the comparison based on bits known to be zero or one
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005305 // in the input. If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
5306 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
5307
5308 bool UnusedBit;
5309 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
5310
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005311 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
5312 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005313 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
5314 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
5315 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005316 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
5317 return &I;
5318
5319 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
5320 // in.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005321 if ((KnownOne | KnownZero) != 0) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005322 // Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
5323 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00005324 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
5325 const APInt& RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005326 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005327 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
5328 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005329 } else {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005330 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
5331 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005332 }
5333 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
5334 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
5335 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005336 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005337 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005338 break;
5339 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005340 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005341 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005342 break;
5343 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005344 if (Max.ult(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005345 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00005346 if (Min.uge(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005347 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005348 break;
5349 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005350 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005351 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00005352 if (Max.ule(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005353 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005354 break;
5355 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005356 if (Max.slt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005357 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005358 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005359 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005360 break;
5361 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005362 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005363 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00005364 if (Max.sle(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005365 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005366 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005367 }
5368 }
5369
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005370 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005371 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005372 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00005373 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005374 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
5375 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005376 }
5377
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005378 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005379 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5380 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5381 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005382 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5383 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005384 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005385 bool isAllZeros = true;
5386 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5387 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5388 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5389 isAllZeros = false;
5390 break;
5391 }
5392 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005393 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005394 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5395 }
5396 break;
5397
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005398 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005399 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5400 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5401 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5402 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5403 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5404 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005405 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005406 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005407 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5408 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5409 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5410 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5411 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5412 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5413 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005414 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5415 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5416 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5417 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5418 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005419 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5420 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005421 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5422 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5423 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5424 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5425 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005426 }
5427 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005428
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005429 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005430 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005431 break;
5432 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005433 case Instruction::Malloc:
5434 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5435 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5436 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5437 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5438 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005439 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005440 }
5441 break;
5442 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005443 }
5444
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005445 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005446 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005447 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005448 return NI;
5449 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005450 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5451 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005452 return NI;
5453
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005454 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005455 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5456 // now.
5457 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5458 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5459 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005460 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5461 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005462 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005463
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005464 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5465 // so eliminate it as well.
5466 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5467 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005468
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005469 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005470 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005471 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005472 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005473 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005474 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00005475 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005476 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005477 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005478 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005479 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005480 }
5481
5482 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005483 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005484 // This comes up when you have code like
5485 // int X = A < B;
5486 // if (X) ...
5487 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005488 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5489 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005490 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005491 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005492 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005493
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005494 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
5495 { Value *A, *B;
5496 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
5497 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
5498 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
5499 }
5500
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005501 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005502 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005503
5504 // -x == -y --> x == y
5505 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
5506 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
5507 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
5508
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005509 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5510 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5511 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5512 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5513 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5514 }
5515
5516 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5517 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5518 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5519 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5520 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005521 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005522 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005523 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5524 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5525 }
5526
5527 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5528 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5529 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5530 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5531 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5532 }
5533 }
5534
5535 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5536 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005537 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5538 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005539 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5540 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005541 }
5542 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005543 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005544 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5545 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005546 }
5547 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005548 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005549 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5550 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005551 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005552
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005553 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5554 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5555 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5556 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5557 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5558
5559 if (A == C) {
5560 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5561 } else if (A == D) {
5562 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5563 } else if (B == C) {
5564 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5565 } else if (B == D) {
5566 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5567 }
5568
5569 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005570 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5571 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005572 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5573 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5574 return &I;
5575 }
5576 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005577 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005578 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005579}
5580
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005581
5582/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
5583/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
5584Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
5585 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
5586 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5587 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
5588
5589 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
5590 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
5591 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
5592 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
5593 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
5594 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
5595 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
5596 // if it finds it.
5597 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
5598 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
5599 return 0;
5600 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005601 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005602
5603 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
5604 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
5605 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
5606 // instead of computing a divide.
5607 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
5608
5609 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
5610 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
5611 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
5612 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
5613 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
5614
5615 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005616 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005617
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005618 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
5619 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
5620 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
5621 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
5622 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
5623 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
5624 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
5625 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
5626 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
5627
5628
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005629 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005630 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005631 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005632 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5633 if (!HiOverflow)
5634 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005635 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005636 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005637 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005638 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
5639 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005640 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005641 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
5642 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5643 if (!HiOverflow)
5644 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005645 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005646 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005647 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
5648 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005649 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH), true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005650 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005651 HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005652 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005653 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005654 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005655 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005656 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
5657 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005658 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
5659 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
5660 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
5661 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005662 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005663 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
5664 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005665 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005666 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS), true) ?-1:0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005667 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
5668 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005669 // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005670 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005671 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? 1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005672 HiBound = Subtract(Prod, DivRHS);
5673 }
5674
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005675 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
5676 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005677 }
5678
5679 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005680 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005681 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
5682 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5683 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5684 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5685 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005686 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005687 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
5688 else if (LoOverflow)
5689 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5690 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
5691 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005692 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005693 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5694 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5695 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5696 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005697 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005698 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
5699 else if (LoOverflow)
5700 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5701 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5702 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005703 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005704 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5705 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005706 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
5707 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5708 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005709 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005710 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005711 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5712 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005713 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005714 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005715 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
5716 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5717 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005718 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5719 else
5720 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
5721 }
5722}
5723
5724
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005725/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
5726///
5727Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
5728 Instruction *LHSI,
5729 ConstantInt *RHS) {
5730 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
5731
5732 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00005733 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005734 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5735 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
5736 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005737 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
5738 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005739 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
5740
5741 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
5742 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
5743 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
5744 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
5745 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5746 return &ICI;
5747 }
5748
5749 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
5750 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5751
5752 // If so, the new one isn't.
5753 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
5754
5755 if (isTrueIfPositive)
5756 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
5757 else
5758 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
5759 }
5760 }
5761 break;
5762 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
5763 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
5764 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
5765 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5766
5767 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
5768 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
5769 // produced, eliminating a cast.
5770 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
5771 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
5772 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
5773 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
5774 // bit would not work.
5775 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00005776 (ICI.isEquality() ||
5777 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005778 uint32_t BitWidth =
5779 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
5780 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
5781 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
5782 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
5783 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
5784 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005785 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005786 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
5787 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5788 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
5789 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
5790 }
5791 }
5792
5793 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
5794 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
5795 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
5796 // access.
5797 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
5798 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
5799 Shift = 0;
5800
5801 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
5802 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
5803 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
5804 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
5805
5806 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
5807 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
5808 // rights, as they sign-extend.
5809 if (ShAmt) {
5810 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
5811 if (!CanFold) {
5812 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
5813 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
5814 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5815 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
5816
5817 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5818 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
5819 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
5820 CanFold = true;
5821 }
5822
5823 if (CanFold) {
5824 Constant *NewCst;
5825 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5826 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
5827 else
5828 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
5829
5830 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
5831 // compared.
5832 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
5833 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
5834 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
5835 // result is always true or false now.
5836 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
5837 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5838 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
5839 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5840 } else {
5841 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
5842 Constant *NewAndCST;
5843 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5844 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
5845 else
5846 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
5847 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
5848 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
5849 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
5850 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
5851 return &ICI;
5852 }
5853 }
5854 }
5855
5856 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
5857 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
5858 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
5859 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
5860 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
5861 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
5862 // Compute C << Y.
5863 Value *NS;
5864 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005865 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005866 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5867 } else {
5868 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005869 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005870 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5871 }
5872 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
5873
5874 // Compute X & (C << Y).
5875 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005876 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005877 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5878
5879 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
5880 return &ICI;
5881 }
5882 }
5883 break;
5884
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005885 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
5886 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5887 if (!ShAmt) break;
5888
5889 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5890
5891 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5892 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5893 // simplified.
5894 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5895 break;
5896
5897 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5898 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5899 // comparison cannot succeed.
5900 Constant *Comp =
5901 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
5902 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5903 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5904 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5905 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5906 }
5907
5908 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5909 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5910 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5911 Constant *Mask =
5912 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005913
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005914 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005915 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005916 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5917 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5918 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5919 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005920 }
5921 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005922
5923 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
5924 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
5925 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
5926 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
5927 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
5928 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
5929 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
5930 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005931 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005932 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5933 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5934
5935 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
5936 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
5937 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005938 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005939 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005940
5941 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005942 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005943 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005944 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005945 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005946
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005947 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5948 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5949 // simplified.
5950 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5951 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5952 break;
5953
5954 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005955
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005956 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5957 // comparison cannot succeed.
5958 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
5959 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
5960 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
5961 else
5962 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
5963
5964 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5965 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5966 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5967 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5968 }
5969
5970 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
5971 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
5972 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00005973 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
5974 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005975 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
5976 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
5977 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
5978 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005979
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00005980 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005981 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5982 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
5983 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005984
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005985 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005986 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005987 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5988 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5989 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5990 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005991 }
5992 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005993 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005994
5995 case Instruction::SDiv:
5996 case Instruction::UDiv:
5997 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
5998 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
5999 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6000 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6001 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6002 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006003 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6004 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6005 DivRHS))
6006 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006007 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006008
6009 case Instruction::Add:
6010 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6011
6012 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6013 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6014 if (!LHSC) break;
6015 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6016
6017 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6018 .subtract(LHSV);
6019
6020 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6021 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
6022 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6023 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6024 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
6025 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6026 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6027 }
6028 } else {
6029 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
6030 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6031 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6032 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
6033 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6034 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6035 }
6036 }
6037 }
6038 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006039 }
6040
6041 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
6042 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6043 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6044
6045 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
6046 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
6047 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
6048 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
6049 case Instruction::SRem:
6050 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
6051 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
6052 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
6053 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
6054 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006055 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006056 BO->getName());
6057 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
6058 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
6059 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
6060 }
6061 }
6062 break;
6063 case Instruction::Add:
6064 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
6065 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6066 if (BO->hasOneUse())
6067 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6068 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
6069 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
6070 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
6071 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
6072 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
6073
6074 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
6075 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
6076 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
6077 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
6078 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006079 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006080 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
6081 Neg->takeName(BO);
6082 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
6083 }
6084 }
6085 break;
6086 case Instruction::Xor:
6087 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
6088 // the explicit xor.
6089 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
6090 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6091 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
6092
6093 // FALLTHROUGH
6094 case Instruction::Sub:
6095 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
6096 if (RHSV == 0)
6097 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6098 BO->getOperand(1));
6099 break;
6100
6101 case Instruction::Or:
6102 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
6103 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
6104 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6105 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
6106 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
6107 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6108 isICMP_NE));
6109 }
6110 break;
6111
6112 case Instruction::And:
6113 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6114 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
6115 // comparison can never succeed!
6116 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
6117 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6118 isICMP_NE));
6119
6120 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
6121 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
6122 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
6123 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
6124 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
6125
6126 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00006127 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006128 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6129 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
6130 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6131 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
6132 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
6133 }
6134
6135 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
6136 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
6137 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6138 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
6139 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6140 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
6141 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
6142 }
6143 }
6144 default: break;
6145 }
6146 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
6147 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
6148 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
6149 AddToWorkList(II);
6150 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
6151 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
6152 return &ICI;
6153 }
6154 }
6155 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006156 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
6157 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006158 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
6159 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
6160 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
6161 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6162 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
6163 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
6164 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
6165 // smaller constant values.
6166 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
6167 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
6168 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
6169 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
6170 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
6171 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
6172 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
6173 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
6174 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
6175 }
6176 }
6177 }
6178 }
6179 return 0;
6180}
6181
6182/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
6183/// We only handle extending casts so far.
6184///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006185Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
6186 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006187 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
6188 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006189 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006190 Value *RHSCIOp;
6191
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006192 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
6193 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
6194 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
6195 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
6196 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
6197 Value *RHSOp = 0;
6198 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00006199 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006200 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6201 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
6202 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
6203 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006204 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006205 }
6206
6207 if (RHSOp)
6208 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
6209 }
6210
6211 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
6212 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006213 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
6214 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00006215 return 0;
6216
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006217 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
6218 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006219
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006220 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006221 // Not an extension from the same type?
6222 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006223 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
6224 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006225
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006226 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006227 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
6228 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
6229 return 0;
6230
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006231 // Deal with equality cases early.
6232 if (ICI.isEquality())
6233 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6234
6235 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
6236 // signed comparison.
6237 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
6238 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6239
6240 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
6241 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00006242 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006243
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006244 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
6245 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6246 if (!CI)
6247 return 0;
6248
6249 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
6250 // reextended to DestTy.
6251 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
6252 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
6253
6254 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
6255 if (Res2 == CI) {
6256 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
6257 // For example, we might have:
6258 // %A = sext short %X to uint
6259 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
6260 // It is incorrect to transform this into
6261 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
6262 // because %A may have negative value.
6263 //
6264 // However, it is OK if SrcTy is bool (See cast-set.ll testcase)
6265 // OR operation is EQ/NE.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006266 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || SrcTy == Type::Int1Ty || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006267 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
6268 else
6269 return 0;
6270 }
6271
6272 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
6273 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
6274
6275 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
6276 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
6277 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006278 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006279 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006280 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006281
6282 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
6283 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
6284 Value *Result;
6285 if (isSignedCmp) {
6286 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00006287 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006288 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006289 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006290 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006291 } else {
6292 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
6293 if (isSignedExt) {
6294 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
6295 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006296 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006297 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
6298 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
6299 } else {
6300 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006301 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006302 }
6303 }
6304
6305 // Finally, return the value computed.
6306 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
6307 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT) {
6308 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
6309 } else {
6310 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
6311 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
6312 "ICmp should be folded!");
6313 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
6314 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
6315 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006316 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006317 }
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006318}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006319
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006320Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
6321 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6322}
6323
6324Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
6325 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6326}
6327
6328Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006329 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
6330 return R;
6331
6332 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
6333
6334 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
6335 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
6336 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
6337 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
6338
6339 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
6340 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
6341 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006342 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006343
6344 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006345}
6346
6347Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
6348 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006349 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006350
6351 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
6352 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006353 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00006354 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
6355 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006356
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006357 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
6358 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00006359 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006360 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006361 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
6362 }
6363 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006364 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
6365 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6366 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006367 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006368 }
6369
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006370 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6371 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
6372 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006373 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006374 return R;
6375
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006376 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006377 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
6378 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006379 return 0;
6380}
6381
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006382Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006383 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006384 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006385
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006386 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
6387 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006388 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6389 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
6390 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006391 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6392 return &I;
6393
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006394 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
6395 // of a signed value.
6396 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006397 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006398 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006399 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
6400 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006401 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006402 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00006403 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006404 }
6405
6406 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
6407 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
6408 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
6409 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006410 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006411 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
6412
6413 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6414 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
6415 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
6416 return R;
6417 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
6418 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6419 return NV;
6420
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006421 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
6422 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
6423 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
6424 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
6425 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
6426 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
6427 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
6428 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
6429 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
6430 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
6431 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
6432 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006433 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006434 I.getName());
6435 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
6436
6437 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
6438 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
6439 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
6440 // other xforms later if dead.
6441 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6442 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6443 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
6444
6445 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
6446 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
6447 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
6448 // mask as appropriate.
6449 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6450 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
6451 else {
6452 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
6453 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
6454 }
6455
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006456 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(MaskV),
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006457 TI->getName());
6458 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
6459
6460 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
6461 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
6462 }
6463 }
6464
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006465 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006466 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6467 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6468 Value *V1, *V2;
6469 ConstantInt *CC;
6470 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006471 default: break;
6472 case Instruction::Add:
6473 case Instruction::And:
6474 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006475 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006476 // These operators commute.
6477 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006478 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
6479 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006480 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006481 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006482 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006483 Op0BO->getName());
6484 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006485 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006486 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006487 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006488 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006489 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006490 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006491 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006492 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006493
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006494 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006495 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006496 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006497 match(Op0BOOp1,
6498 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006499 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6500 V2 == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006501 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006502 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
6503 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006504 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6505 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006506 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006507 V1->getName()+".mask");
6508 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6509
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006510 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006511 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006512 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006513
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006514 // FALL THROUGH.
6515 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006516 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006517 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6518 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006519 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006520 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006521 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6522 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006523 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006524 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006525 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006526 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006527 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006528 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006529 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006530 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006531 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006532
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00006533 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006534 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6535 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
6536 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006537 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006538 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
6539 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006540 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006541 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6542 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006543 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6544 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006545 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006546 V1->getName()+".mask");
6547 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6548
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006549 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006550 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006551
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006552 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006553 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006554 }
6555
6556
6557 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
6558 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
6559 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
6560 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
6561 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
6562
6563 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006564 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00006565 case Instruction::Add:
6566 isValid = isLeftShift;
6567 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006568 case Instruction::Or:
6569 case Instruction::Xor:
6570 highBitSet = false;
6571 break;
6572 case Instruction::And:
6573 highBitSet = true;
6574 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006575 }
6576
6577 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
6578 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
6579 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
6580 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
6581 // operation.
6582 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00006583 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006584 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006585
6586 if (isValid) {
6587 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
6588
6589 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006590 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006591 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006592 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006593
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006594 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006595 NewRHS);
6596 }
6597 }
6598 }
6599 }
6600
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006601 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006602 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
6603 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
6604 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006605
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006606 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006607 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006608 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6609 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006610 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
6611 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
6612 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006613
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006614 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006615 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
6616 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006617
6618 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
6619
6620 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00006621 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006622 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006623 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6624 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
6625 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
6626 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006627 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006628 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
6629 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6630 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
6631 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006632 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006633 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6634
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006635 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006636 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006637 }
6638
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006639 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
6640 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
6641 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
6642 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
6643 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006644 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006645 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006646 }
6647 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
6648 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00006649 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006650 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006651 }
6652 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
6653 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
6654 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
6655 // generators.
6656 const Type *SExtType = 0;
6657 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006658 case 1 :
6659 case 8 :
6660 case 16 :
6661 case 32 :
6662 case 64 :
6663 case 128:
6664 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
6665 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006666 default: break;
6667 }
6668 if (SExtType) {
6669 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
6670 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
6671 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
6672 }
6673 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
6674 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006675 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006676
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006677 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006678 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6679 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6680 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006681 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006682 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006683 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6684
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006685 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006686 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006687 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006688
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006689 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006690 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6691 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6692 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006693 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006694 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006695
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00006696 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006697 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006698 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006699
6700 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
6701 } else {
6702 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006703 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006704
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006705 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006706 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6707 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6708 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
6709 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006710 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006711 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6712 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6713
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006714 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006715 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006716 }
6717
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006718 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006719 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6720 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6721 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006722 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006723 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6724
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00006725 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006726 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006727 }
6728
6729 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006730 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006731 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006732 return 0;
6733}
6734
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00006735
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006736/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
6737/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
6738/// X*Scale+Offset.
6739///
6740static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006741 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006742 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006743 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006744 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006745 Scale = 0;
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006746 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006747 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
6748 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
6749 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6750 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
6751 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
6752 Offset = 0;
6753 return I->getOperand(0);
6754 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
6755 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
6756 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
6757 Offset = 0;
6758 return I->getOperand(0);
6759 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6760 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
6761 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
6762 unsigned SubScale;
6763 Value *SubVal =
6764 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
6765 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
6766 Scale = SubScale;
6767 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006768 }
6769 }
6770 }
6771
6772 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
6773 Scale = 1;
6774 Offset = 0;
6775 return Val;
6776}
6777
6778
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006779/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
6780/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006781Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006782 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006783 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006784
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006785 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
6786 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00006787
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006788 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
6789 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
6790 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
6791 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
6792 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
6793
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006794 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00006795 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00006796 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006797 }
6798 }
6799
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006800 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
6801 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
6802 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
6803 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006804
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00006805 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
6806 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006807 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6808
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006809 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
6810 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
6811 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
6812 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6813
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00006814 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(AllocElTy);
6815 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006816 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006817
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006818 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
6819 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006820 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
6821 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006822 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
6823 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
6824
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006825 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
6826 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006827 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
6828 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006829
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006830 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
6831 Value *Amt = 0;
6832 if (Scale == 1) {
6833 Amt = NumElements;
6834 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006835 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006836 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
6837 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00006838 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006839 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006840 else if (Scale != 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006841 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006842 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006843 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006844 }
6845
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006846 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
6847 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006848 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006849 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
6850 }
6851
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006852 AllocationInst *New;
6853 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006854 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006855 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006856 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006857 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006858 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006859
6860 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
6861 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
6862 // die soon.
6863 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
6864 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006865 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
6866 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
6867 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006868 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
6869 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
6870 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006871 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
6872}
6873
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006874/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006875/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
6876/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
6877/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
6878/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
6879///
6880/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
6881/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00006882///
6883/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
6884/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
6885/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
6886/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
6887/// efficiently truncated.
6888///
6889/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
6890/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
6891/// the final result.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00006892bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
6893 unsigned CastOpc,
6894 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006895 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
6896 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
6897 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006898
6899 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006900 if (!I) return false;
6901
6902 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006903
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006904 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
6905 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
6906 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
6907 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
6908 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
6909 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
6910 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
6911 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00006912 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006913 ++NumCastsRemoved;
6914 return true;
6915 }
6916 }
6917
6918 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
6919 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
6920 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6921
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006922 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006923 case Instruction::Add:
6924 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006925 case Instruction::And:
6926 case Instruction::Or:
6927 case Instruction::Xor:
6928 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006929 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6930 NumCastsRemoved) &&
6931 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
6932 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006933
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00006934 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00006935 // A multiply can be truncated by truncating its operands.
6936 return Ty->getBitWidth() < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
6937 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6938 NumCastsRemoved) &&
6939 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
6940 NumCastsRemoved);
6941
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006942 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006943 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
6944 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
6945 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006946 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6947 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
6948 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006949 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6950 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006951 }
6952 break;
6953 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006954 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
6955 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
6956 // already zeros.
6957 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006958 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
6959 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6960 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006961 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006962 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
6963 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006964 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6965 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006966 }
6967 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006968 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006969 case Instruction::ZExt:
6970 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006971 case Instruction::Trunc:
6972 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00006973 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
6974 // of casts in the input.
6975 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006976 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006977 break;
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00006978
6979 case Instruction::PHI: {
6980 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
6981 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
6982 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
6983 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
6984 NumCastsRemoved))
6985 return false;
6986 return true;
6987 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006988 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006989 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6990 break;
6991 }
6992
6993 return false;
6994}
6995
6996/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
6997/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
6998/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006999Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007000 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007001 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007002 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007003
7004 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7005 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007006 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007007 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007008 case Instruction::Add:
7009 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007010 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007011 case Instruction::And:
7012 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007013 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007014 case Instruction::AShr:
7015 case Instruction::LShr:
7016 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007017 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007018 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007019 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007020 LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007021 break;
7022 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007023 case Instruction::Trunc:
7024 case Instruction::ZExt:
7025 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007026 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007027 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7028 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007029 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7030 return I->getOperand(0);
7031
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007032 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007033 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007034 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007035 break;
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007036 case Instruction::PHI: {
7037 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7038 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
7039 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7040 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
7041 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
7042 }
7043 Res = NPN;
7044 break;
7045 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007046 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007047 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7048 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
7049 break;
7050 }
7051
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007052 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007053 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
7054}
7055
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007056/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
7057Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00007058 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7059
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00007060 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007061 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007062 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007063 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
7064 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
7065 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
7066 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007067 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00007068 }
7069 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00007070
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007071 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007072 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
7073 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
7074 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007075
7076 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007077 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
7078 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
7079 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007080
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007081 return 0;
7082}
7083
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007084/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
7085Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7086 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7087
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007088 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007089 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
7090 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007091 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
7092 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
7093 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
7094 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007095 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007096 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
7097 return &CI;
7098 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007099
7100 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
7101 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
7102 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
7103 // non-type-safe code.
7104 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
7105 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
7106 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
7107 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
7108 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
7109
7110 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
7111 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
7112 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
7113 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
7114 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
7115 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
7116
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007117 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
7118 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
7119 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007120 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007121 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007122 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getABITypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007123 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
7124 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007125
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007126 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
7127 if (Offset < 0) {
7128 --FirstIdx;
7129 Offset += TySize;
7130 assert(Offset >= 0);
7131 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007132 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007133 }
7134
7135 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007136
7137 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
7138 while (Offset) {
7139 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7140 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007141 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
7142 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
7143 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007144
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007145 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
7146 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
7147 } else {
7148 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7149 Offset = 0;
7150 OrigBase = 0;
7151 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007152 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7153 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007154 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getABITypeSize(STy->getElementType())){
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007155 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
7156 Offset %= EltSize;
7157 } else {
7158 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
7159 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007160 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
7161 } else {
7162 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7163 Offset = 0;
7164 OrigBase = 0;
7165 }
7166 }
7167 if (OrigBase) {
7168 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
7169 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
7170 // two.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007171 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
7172 NewIndices.begin(),
7173 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007174 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
7175 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
7176
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007177 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
7178 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7179 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
7180 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7181 }
7182 }
7183 }
7184 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007185 }
7186
7187 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7188}
7189
7190
7191
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007192/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
7193/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007194/// cases.
7195/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
7196Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7197 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7198 return Result;
7199
7200 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7201 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7202 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007203 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7204 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007205
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007206 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
7207 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007208 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
7209 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007210 KnownZero, KnownOne))
7211 return &CI;
7212
7213 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
7214 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007215 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
7216 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007217 return 0;
7218
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007219 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007220 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007221 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
7222 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007223 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007224 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007225 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
7226 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
7227 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
7228 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007229 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007230 bool DoXForm;
7231 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7232 default:
7233 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
7234 // get here because of the check above.
7235 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
7236 case Instruction::Trunc:
7237 DoXForm = true;
7238 break;
7239 case Instruction::ZExt:
7240 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
7241 break;
7242 case Instruction::SExt:
7243 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
7244 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007245 }
7246
7247 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007248 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
7249 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007250 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
7251 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7252 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
7253 case Instruction::Trunc:
7254 case Instruction::BitCast:
7255 // Just replace this cast with the result.
7256 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7257 case Instruction::ZExt: {
7258 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
7259 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00007260 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
7261 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007262 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007263 }
7264 case Instruction::SExt:
7265 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007266 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007267 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
7268 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007269 }
7270 }
7271 }
7272
7273 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
7274 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
7275
7276 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7277 case Instruction::Add:
7278 case Instruction::Mul:
7279 case Instruction::And:
7280 case Instruction::Or:
7281 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007282 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007283 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
7284 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7285 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7286 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
7287 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007288 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
7289 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00007290 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007291 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7292 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007293 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007294 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007295 }
7296 }
7297
7298 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
7299 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
7300 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007301 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007302 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007303 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007304 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007305 }
7306 break;
7307 case Instruction::SDiv:
7308 case Instruction::UDiv:
7309 case Instruction::SRem:
7310 case Instruction::URem:
7311 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
7312 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
7313 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7314 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7315 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007316 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
7317 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007318 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7319 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7320 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7321 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007322 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007323 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
7324 }
7325 }
7326 break;
7327
7328 case Instruction::Shl:
7329 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
7330 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
7331 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
7332 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
7333 // in the value.
7334 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
7335 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007336 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
7337 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
7338 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007339 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007340 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007341 }
7342 break;
7343 case Instruction::AShr:
7344 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
7345 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
7346 // simplifications.
7347 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
7348 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007349 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007350 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
7351 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007352 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007353 }
7354 }
7355 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007356 }
7357 return 0;
7358}
7359
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007360Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007361 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7362 return Result;
7363
7364 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7365 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007366 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7367 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007368
7369 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
7370 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7371 default: break;
7372 case Instruction::LShr:
7373 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
7374 // are already zeros.
7375 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007376 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007377
7378 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007379 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007380 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
7381 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007382 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
7383 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
7384
7385 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
7386 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007387 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
7388 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
7389 Ty, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007390 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007391 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007392 } else { // This is a variable shr.
7393
7394 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
7395 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
7396 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007397 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007398 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
7399
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007400 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007401 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007402 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007403 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V,
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007404 SrcI->getOperand(0),
7405 "tmp"), CI);
7406 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007407 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007408 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007409 }
7410 break;
7411 }
7412 }
7413
7414 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007415}
7416
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007417/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
7418/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
7419Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
7420 bool DoXform) {
7421 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7422 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7423 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7424 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7425 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7426
7427 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
7428 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
7429 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7430 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
7431 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7432
7433 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7434 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7435 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007436 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007437 In->getName()+".lobit"),
7438 CI);
7439 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007440 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007441 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7442
7443 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
7444 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007445 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007446 In->getName()+".not"),
7447 CI);
7448 }
7449
7450 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7451 }
7452
7453
7454
7455 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7456 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7457 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7458 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7459 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7460 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7461 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7462 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7463 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
7464 // This only works for EQ and NE
7465 ICI->isEquality()) {
7466 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
7467 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
7468 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
7469 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
7470 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
7471
7472 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
7473 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
7474 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7475
7476 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7477 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
7478 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
7479 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
7480 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
7481 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
7482 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7483 }
7484
7485 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
7486 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7487 if (ShiftAmt) {
7488 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
7489 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007490 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007491 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
7492 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
7493 }
7494
7495 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
7496 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007497 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007498 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
7499 }
7500
7501 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
7502 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7503 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007504 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007505 }
7506 }
7507 }
7508
7509 return 0;
7510}
7511
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007512Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007513 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
7514 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7515 return Result;
7516
7517 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7518
7519 // If this is a cast of a cast
7520 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007521 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
7522 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
7523 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
7524 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
7525 // Get the sizes of the types involved
7526 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007527 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7528 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7529 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007530 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
7531 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
7532 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007533 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007534 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007535 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007536 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007537 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
7538 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
7539 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
7540 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007541 And = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007542 }
7543 return And;
7544 }
7545 }
7546 }
7547
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007548 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
7549 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00007550
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007551 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
7552 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
7553 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
7554 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
7555 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
7556 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
7557 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
7558 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
7559 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
7560 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
7561 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007562 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00007563 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007564 }
7565
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007566 return 0;
7567}
7568
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007569Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007570 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7571 return I;
7572
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007573 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7574
7575 // sext (x <s 0) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
7576 // sext (x >s -1) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
7577 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
7578 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7579 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7580 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7581 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7582 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7583
7584 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
7585 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
7586 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7587 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
7588 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7589 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7590 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007591 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007592 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007593 CI);
7594 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007595 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007596 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7597
7598 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007599 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007600 In->getName()+".not"), CI);
7601
7602 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7603 }
7604 }
7605 }
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00007606
7607 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
7608 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
7609 if (getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
7610 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
7611 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth();
7612 unsigned MidBits = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
7613 unsigned DestBits = cast<IntegerType>(CI.getType())->getBitWidth();
7614 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
7615
7616 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
7617 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
7618 // bits, it is already ready.
7619 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
7620 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
7621 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
7622 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
7623 // bits, just sext from i32.
7624 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
7625 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
7626 } else {
7627 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
7628 // bits, just truncate to i32.
7629 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
7630 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
7631 }
7632 }
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007633
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007634 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007635}
7636
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007637/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
7638/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007639static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem) {
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007640 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
7641 if (F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven) == APFloat::opOK)
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007642 return ConstantFP::get(F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007643 return 0;
7644}
7645
7646/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
7647/// through it until we get the source value.
7648static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V) {
7649 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
7650 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
7651 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0));
7652
7653 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
7654 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
7655 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
7656 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
7657 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
7658 return V; // No constant folding of this.
7659 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007660 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007661 return V;
7662 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
7663 return V; // Won't shrink.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007664 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007665 return V;
7666 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
7667 }
7668
7669 return V;
7670}
7671
7672Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
7673 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7674 return I;
7675
7676 // If we have fptrunc(add (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
7677 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
7678 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to add/sub/mul/div as well as
7679 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
7680 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
7681 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
7682 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
7683 default: break;
7684 case Instruction::Add:
7685 case Instruction::Sub:
7686 case Instruction::Mul:
7687 case Instruction::FDiv:
7688 case Instruction::FRem:
7689 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
7690 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0));
7691 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1));
7692 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
7693 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
7694 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7695 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
7696 // the cast, do this xform.
7697 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
7698 RHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
7699 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
7700 CI.getType(), CI);
7701 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
7702 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007703 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007704 }
7705 }
7706 break;
7707 }
7708 }
7709 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007710}
7711
7712Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
7713 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7714}
7715
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007716Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
7717 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X if the intermediate type has enough bits in its
7718 // mantissa to accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not
7719 // do this with i64->float->i64.
7720 if (UIToFPInst *SrcI = dyn_cast<UIToFPInst>(FI.getOperand(0)))
7721 if (SrcI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
7722 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00007723 SrcI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007724 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, SrcI->getOperand(0));
7725
7726 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007727}
7728
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007729Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
7730 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X if the intermediate type has enough bits in its
7731 // mantissa to accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not
7732 // do this with i64->float->i64.
7733 if (SIToFPInst *SrcI = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(FI.getOperand(0)))
7734 if (SrcI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
7735 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <=
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00007736 SrcI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007737 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, SrcI->getOperand(0));
7738
7739 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007740}
7741
7742Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7743 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7744}
7745
7746Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7747 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7748}
7749
7750Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007751 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007752}
7753
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007754Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
7755 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7756 return I;
7757
7758 const Type *DestPointee = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())->getElementType();
7759 if (!DestPointee->isSized()) return 0;
7760
7761 // If this is inttoptr(add (ptrtoint x), cst), try to turn this into a GEP.
7762 ConstantInt *Cst;
7763 Value *X;
7764 if (match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Cast<PtrToIntInst>(m_Value(X)),
7765 m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
7766 // If the source and destination operands have the same type, see if this
7767 // is a single-index GEP.
7768 if (X->getType() == CI.getType()) {
7769 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Bill Wendlingb9d4f8d2008-03-14 05:12:19 +00007770 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007771
7772 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
7773 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
7774 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
7775
7776 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
7777 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
7778 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007779 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, ConstantInt::get(Offset));
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007780 }
7781 }
7782 // TODO: Could handle other cases, e.g. where add is indexing into field of
7783 // struct etc.
7784 } else if (CI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7785 match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
7786 // Otherwise, if this is inttoptr(add x, cst), try to turn this into an
7787 // "inttoptr+GEP" instead of "add+intptr".
7788
7789 // Get the size of the pointee type.
7790 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
7791
7792 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
7793 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
7794 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
7795
7796 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
7797 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
7798 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
7799
7800 Instruction *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new IntToPtrInst(X, CI.getType(),
7801 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007802 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(P, ConstantInt::get(Offset), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007803 }
7804 }
7805 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007806}
7807
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007808Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007809 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
7810 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
7811 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7812 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7813 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
7814
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007815 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007816 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7817 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007818 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
7819 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
7820 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007821 } else {
7822 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7823 return Result;
7824 }
7825
7826
7827 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
7828 // be replaced by the operand.
7829 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
7830 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
7831
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007832 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007833 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
7834 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
7835 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
7836
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00007837 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
7838 // required for changing types.
7839 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
7840 return 0;
7841
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007842 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
7843 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
7844 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
7845 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
7846 return V;
7847
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007848 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
7849 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007850 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
7851 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
7852 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
7853 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
7854 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
7855 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
7856 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
7857 ++NumZeros;
7858 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007859
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007860 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
7861 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
7862 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007863 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
7864 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007865 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007866 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00007867
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007868 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
7869 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
7870 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
7871 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007872 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
7873 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007874 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
7875 CastInst *Tmp;
7876 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
7877 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
7878 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
7879 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
7880 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
7881 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
7882 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007883 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7884 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
7885 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7886 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007887 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
7888 // know the vector types match #elts.
7889 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00007890 }
7891 }
7892 }
7893 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00007894 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00007895}
7896
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007897/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
7898/// %C = or %A, %B
7899/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
7900/// into:
7901/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
7902/// %D = or %A, %C
7903///
7904/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
7905/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
7906/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
7907///
7908static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
7909 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7910 case Instruction::Add:
7911 case Instruction::Mul:
7912 case Instruction::And:
7913 case Instruction::Or:
7914 case Instruction::Xor:
7915 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
7916 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
7917 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007918 case Instruction::LShr:
7919 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007920 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007921 default:
7922 return 0; // Cannot fold
7923 }
7924}
7925
7926/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
7927/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
7928static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
7929 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7930 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
7931 case Instruction::Add:
7932 case Instruction::Sub:
7933 case Instruction::Or:
7934 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007935 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007936 case Instruction::LShr:
7937 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007938 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007939 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00007940 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007941 case Instruction::Mul:
7942 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
7943 }
7944}
7945
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007946/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
7947/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
7948Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
7949 Instruction *FI) {
7950 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
7951 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
7952 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007953 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007954 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
7955 return 0;
7956 } else {
7957 return 0; // unknown unary op.
7958 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007959
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007960 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007961 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
7962 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007963 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007964 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007965 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007966 }
7967
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007968 // Only handle binary operators here.
7969 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007970 return 0;
7971
7972 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
7973 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
7974 bool MatchIsOpZero;
7975 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7976 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7977 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7978 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7979 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7980 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7981 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7982 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7983 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7984 MatchIsOpZero = false;
7985 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
7986 return 0;
7987 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7988 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7989 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7990 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7991 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7992 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7993 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7994 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7995 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7996 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7997 } else {
7998 return 0;
7999 }
8000
8001 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008002 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
8003 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008004 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
8005
8006 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
8007 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008008 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008009 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008010 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008011 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00008012 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
8013 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008014}
8015
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008016Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008017 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
8018 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8019 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8020
8021 // select true, X, Y -> X
8022 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008023 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008024 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008025
8026 // select C, X, X -> X
8027 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
8028 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8029
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008030 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
8031 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8032 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
8033 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8034 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
8035 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8036 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8037 else
8038 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8039 }
8040
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008041 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008042 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008043 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008044 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008045 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008046 } else {
8047 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
8048 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008049 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008050 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008051 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008052 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008053 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008054 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008055 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008056 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008057 } else {
8058 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
8059 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008060 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008061 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008062 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008063 }
8064 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008065
8066 // select a, b, a -> a&b
8067 // select a, a, b -> a|b
8068 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008069 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008070 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008071 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008072 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008073
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008074 // Selecting between two integer constants?
8075 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
8076 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008077 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008078 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008079 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008080 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008081 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008082 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008083 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008084 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008085 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008086 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008087
8088 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008089
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008090 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008091
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008092 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008093 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008094 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008095 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008096 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008097 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008098 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008099 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008100 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008101 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, X,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008102 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008103 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
8104
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008105 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
8106 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
8107 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008108 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8109 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008110 if (SRASize < SISize)
8111 opc = Instruction::SExt;
8112 else if (SRASize > SISize)
8113 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008114 return CastInst::Create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008115 }
8116 }
8117
8118
8119 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008120 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008121 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
8122 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008123 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00008124 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008125 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
8126 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
8127 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008128 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
8129 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
8130 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008131 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
8132 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008133 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
8134 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008135 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008136 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008137 Value *V = ICA;
8138 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008139 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008140 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
8141 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
8142 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008143 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008144 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008145
8146 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008147 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8148 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008149 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008150 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8151 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8152 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8153 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8154 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8155 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8156 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8157 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8158 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008159 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008160 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008161 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008162 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008163 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8164 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8165
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008166 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008167 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008168 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8169 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8170 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8171 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8172 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8173 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8174 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8175 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8176 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
8177 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8178 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008179 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008180 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
8181 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8182 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8183 }
8184 }
8185
8186 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
8187 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8188 if (ICI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
8189 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
8190 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8191 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8192 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
8193 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8194 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8195 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8196
8197 } else if (ICI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
8198 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
8199 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8200 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8201 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
8202 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Chris Lattnerfbede522004-04-11 01:39:19 +00008203 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008204 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8205 }
8206 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008207
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008208 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8209 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8210 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008211 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
8212
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008213 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
8214 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
8215 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
8216 return IV;
8217
8218 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
8219 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008220 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8221 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8222 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
8223 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8224 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8225 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
8226 }
8227
8228 if (AddOp) {
8229 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
8230 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
8231 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
8232 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
8233 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
8234 }
8235
8236 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008237 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
8238 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
8239 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
8240 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
8241 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
8242 } else {
8243 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008244 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008245 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008246
8247 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
8248 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
8249 if (AddOp != TI)
8250 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
8251 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008252 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
8253 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008254
8255 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008256 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008257 }
8258 }
8259 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008260
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008261 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008262 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008263 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
8264 // transformation we are doing here.
8265 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8266 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8267 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
8268 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
8269 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8270 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
8271 OpToFold = 1;
8272 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
8273 OpToFold = 2;
8274 }
8275
8276 if (OpToFold) {
8277 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008278 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008279 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(),
8280 TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008281 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008282 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008283 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008284 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008285 else {
8286 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
8287 }
8288 }
8289 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00008290
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008291 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8292 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8293 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8294 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
8295 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8296 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
8297 OpToFold = 1;
8298 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
8299 OpToFold = 2;
8300 }
8301
8302 if (OpToFold) {
8303 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008304 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008305 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C,
8306 FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008307 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008308 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008309 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008310 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008311 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008312 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008313 }
8314 }
8315 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00008316
8317 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
8318 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
8319 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
8320 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
8321 return &SI;
8322 }
8323
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008324 return 0;
8325}
8326
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008327/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
8328/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
8329/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
8330/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
8331/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
8332///
8333static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8334 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008335
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008336 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
8337 if (!U) return Align;
8338
8339 switch (getOpcode(U)) {
8340 default: break;
8341 case Instruction::BitCast:
8342 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
8343 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008344 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
8345 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00008346 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00008347 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
8348 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008349 AllZeroOperands = false;
8350 break;
8351 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008352
8353 if (AllZeroOperands) {
8354 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008355 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008356 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008357 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008358 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008359 }
8360
8361 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
8362 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
8363 // of the global.
8364 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
8365 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8366 Align = PrefAlign;
8367 }
8368 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
8369 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
8370 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
8371 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
8372 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8373 Align = PrefAlign;
8374 }
8375 }
8376
8377 return Align;
8378}
8379
8380/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
8381/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
8382/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
8383/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
8384unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8385 unsigned PrefAlign) {
8386 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
8387 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
8388 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
8389 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8390 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8391 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
8392 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
8393
8394 if (PrefAlign > Align)
8395 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
8396
8397 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
8398 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008399}
8400
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008401Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008402 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
8403 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008404 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
8405 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
8406
8407 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
8408 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, MinAlign));
8409 return MI;
8410 }
8411
8412 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
8413 // load/store.
8414 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
8415 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
8416
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008417 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
8418 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
8419 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
8420 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008421 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008422 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
8423
8424 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008425 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008426
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008427 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008428 Type *NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008429
8430 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
8431 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
8432 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
8433 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
8434 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
8435 // integer datatype.
8436 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
8437 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
8438 if (SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
8439 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
8440 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008441 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008442 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
8443 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
8444 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
8445 else
8446 break;
8447 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
8448 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
8449 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
8450 else
8451 break;
8452 } else
8453 break;
8454 }
8455
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008456 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008457 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
8458 }
8459 }
8460
8461
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008462 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
8463 // infer, use it.
8464 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
8465 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
8466
8467 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
8468 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008469 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
8470 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
8471 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
8472
8473 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
8474 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
8475 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008476}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008477
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008478Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
8479 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
8480 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
8481 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
8482 return MI;
8483 }
8484
8485 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
8486 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
8487 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
8488 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
8489 return 0;
8490 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
8491 Alignment = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
8492
8493 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
8494 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
8495
8496 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
8497 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
8498 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
8499
8500 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
8501 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy), *MI);
8502
8503 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
8504 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
8505
8506 // Extract the fill value and store.
8507 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
8508 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill), Dest, false,
8509 Alignment), *MI);
8510
8511 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
8512 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
8513 return MI;
8514 }
8515
8516 return 0;
8517}
8518
8519
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008520/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
8521/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
8522/// the heavy lifting.
8523///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008524Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008525 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
8526 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
8527
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008528 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
8529 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008530 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008531 bool Changed = false;
8532
8533 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
8534 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
8535 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
8536
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008537 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008538 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008539 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
8540 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
8541 // alignment is sufficient.
8542 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008543 }
8544
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008545 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
8546 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
8547 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008548 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008549 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
8550 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
8551 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00008552 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID;
8553 if (CI.getOperand(3)->getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
8554 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i32;
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00008555 else
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00008556 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i64;
8557 CI.setOperand(0, Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008558 Changed = true;
8559 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00008560
8561 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
8562 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
8563 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008564 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008565
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008566 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
8567 // set, update the alignment.
8568 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008569 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
8570 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008571 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
8572 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
8573 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008574 }
8575
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008576 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008577 }
8578
8579 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
8580 default: break;
8581 case Intrinsic::bswap:
8582 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
8583 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
8584 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
8585 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
8586 break;
8587 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
8588 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
8589 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
8590 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
8591 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
8592 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
8593 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
8594 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
8595 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
8596 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()),
8597 CI);
8598 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008599 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008600 break;
8601 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
8602 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
8603 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
8604 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
8605 const Type *OpPtrTy =
8606 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
8607 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
8608 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
8609 }
8610 break;
8611 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
8612 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
8613 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
8614 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storel_dq:
8615 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
8616 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
8617 const Type *OpPtrTy =
8618 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
8619 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
8620 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
8621 }
8622 break;
8623
8624 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
8625 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
8626 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
8627 uint64_t UndefElts;
8628 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
8629 UndefElts)) {
8630 II->setOperand(1, V);
8631 return II;
8632 }
8633 break;
8634 }
8635
8636 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
8637 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
8638 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
8639 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008640
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008641 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
8642 bool AllEltsOk = true;
8643 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
8644 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
8645 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
8646 AllEltsOk = false;
8647 break;
8648 }
8649 }
8650
8651 if (AllEltsOk) {
8652 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
8653 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
8654 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
8655 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008656
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008657 // Only extract each element once.
8658 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
8659 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
8660
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008661 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008662 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
8663 continue;
8664 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
8665 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
8666
8667 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
8668 Instruction *Elt =
8669 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
8670 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
8671 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008672 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008673
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008674 // Insert this value into the result vector.
8675 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
8676 i, "tmp");
8677 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008678 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008679 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008680 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008681 }
8682 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008683
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008684 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
8685 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
8686 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
8687 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
8688 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
8689 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
8690 if (&*++BI == II)
8691 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00008692 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008693 }
8694
8695 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
8696 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
8697 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
8698 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
8699 bool CannotRemove = false;
8700 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
8701 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
8702 CannotRemove = true;
8703 break;
8704 }
8705 if (isa<CallInst>(BI)) {
8706 if (!isa<IntrinsicInst>(BI)) {
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00008707 CannotRemove = true;
8708 break;
8709 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008710 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00008711 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008712 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00008713 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008714
8715 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
8716 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
8717 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
8718 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
8719 break;
8720 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008721 }
8722
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008723 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008724}
8725
8726// InvokeInst simplification
8727//
8728Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008729 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008730}
8731
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00008732/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
8733/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00008734static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
8735 const CastInst * const CI,
8736 const TargetData * const TD,
8737 const int ix) {
8738 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
8739 return false;
8740
8741 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
8742 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
8743 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
8744 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, ParamAttr::ByVal))
8745 return true;
8746
8747 const Type* SrcTy =
8748 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
8749 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
8750 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
8751 return false;
8752 if (TD->getABITypeSize(SrcTy) != TD->getABITypeSize(DstTy))
8753 return false;
8754 return true;
8755}
8756
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008757// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
8758//
8759Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008760 bool Changed = false;
8761
8762 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
8763 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008764 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
8765
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008766 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008767
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00008768 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
8769 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
8770 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
8771 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
8772 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008773 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00008774 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
8775 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00008776 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
8777 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
8778 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
8779 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
8780 return 0;
8781 }
8782
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008783 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
8784 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
8785 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
8786 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008787 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00008788 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008789 CS.getInstruction());
8790
8791 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
8792 CS.getInstruction()->
8793 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
8794
8795 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
8796 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008797 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
8798 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008799 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008800 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
8801 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008802
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00008803 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
8804 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
8805 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
8806 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
8807
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008808 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
8809 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
8810 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +00008811 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008812 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
8813 // the call.
8814 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00008815 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
8816 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
8817 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
8818 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
8819 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008820 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00008821 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008822 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008823
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00008824 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00008825 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00008826 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00008827 Changed = true;
8828 }
8829
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008830 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008831}
8832
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008833// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
8834// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
8835//
8836bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
8837 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
8838 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008839 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
8840 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008841 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00008842 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008843 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008844 const PAListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getParamAttrs();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008845
8846 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
8847 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
8848 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
8849 //
8850 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
8851 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008852 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008853
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008854 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +00008855 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
8856
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008857 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008858 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +00008859 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008860 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
8861 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
8862 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
Duncan Sands34b176a2008-06-17 15:55:30 +00008863 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00008864 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008865
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008866 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008867 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008868 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008869 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
8870
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008871 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
8872 ParameterAttributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(0);
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008873 if (RAttrs & ParamAttr::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +00008874 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
8875 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008876
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008877 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
8878 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
8879 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
8880 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
8881 if (!Caller->use_empty())
8882 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
8883 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
8884 UI != E; ++UI)
8885 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
8886 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00008887 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008888 return false;
8889 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008890
8891 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
8892 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008893
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008894 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
8895 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
8896 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00008897 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008898
8899 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008900 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
8901
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008902 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(i + 1) & ParamAttr::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
8903 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008904
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008905 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
8906 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00008907 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008908 ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
8909 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType()));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008910 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008911 }
8912
8913 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008914 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008915 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008916
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008917 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
8918 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008919 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00008920 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
8921 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008922 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
8923 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00008924 break;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008925 ParameterAttributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00008926 if (PAttrs & ParamAttr::VarArgsIncompatible)
8927 return false;
8928 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008929
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008930 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
8931 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
8932 std::vector<Value*> Args;
8933 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008934 SmallVector<ParamAttrsWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008935 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
8936
8937 // Get any return attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008938 ParameterAttributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(0);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008939
8940 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
8941 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008942 RAttrs &= ~ParamAttr::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008943
8944 // Add the new return attributes.
8945 if (RAttrs)
8946 attrVec.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008947
8948 AI = CS.arg_begin();
8949 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
8950 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
8951 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
8952 Args.push_back(*AI);
8953 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008954 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008955 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008956 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008957 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008958 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008959
8960 // Add any parameter attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008961 if (ParameterAttributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(i + 1))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008962 attrVec.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008963 }
8964
8965 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
8966 // now...
8967 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
8968 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
8969
8970 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00008971 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008972 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00008973 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
8974 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008975 } else {
8976 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
8977 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
8978 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
8979 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
8980 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008981 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
8982 PTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008983 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008984 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
8985 Args.push_back(Cast);
8986 } else {
8987 Args.push_back(*AI);
8988 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008989
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00008990 // Add any parameter attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008991 if (ParameterAttributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(i + 1))
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00008992 attrVec.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
8993 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008994 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00008995 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008996
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008997 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008998 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008999
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009000 const PAListPtr &NewCallerPAL = PAListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009001
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009002 Instruction *NC;
9003 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009004 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009005 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9006 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00009007 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009008 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setParamAttrs(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009009 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009010 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9011 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009012 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
9013 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00009014 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009015 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009016 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setParamAttrs(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009017 }
9018
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009019 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009020 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009021 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009022 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009023 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009024 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009025 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009026
9027 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
9028 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
9029 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +00009030 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009031 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
9032 } else {
9033 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
9034 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
9035 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009036 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009037 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00009038 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009039 }
9040 }
9041
9042 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9043 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00009044 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009045 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009046 return true;
9047}
9048
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009049// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
9050// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
9051//
9052Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
9053 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
9054 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9055 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009056 const PAListPtr &Attrs = CS.getParamAttrs();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009057
9058 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
9059 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009060 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(ParamAttr::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009061 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009062
9063 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
9064 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
9065
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +00009066 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009067 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
9068 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
9069
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009070 const PAListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getParamAttrs();
9071 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009072 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
9073 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Dale Johannesen0d51e7e2008-02-19 21:38:47 +00009074 ParameterAttributes NestAttr = ParamAttr::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009075
9076 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
9077 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
9078 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009079 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, ParamAttr::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009080 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
9081 NestTy = *I;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009082 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttrs(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009083 break;
9084 }
9085
9086 if (NestTy) {
9087 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
9088 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
9089 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
9090
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009091 SmallVector<ParamAttrsWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
9092 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009093
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009094 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009095 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
9096
9097 // Add any function result attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009098 if (ParameterAttributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttrs(0))
9099 NewAttrs.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009100
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009101 {
9102 unsigned Idx = 1;
9103 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
9104 do {
9105 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009106 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009107 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
9108 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
9109 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
9110 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009111 NewAttrs.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009112 }
9113
9114 if (I == E)
9115 break;
9116
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009117 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009118 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009119 if (ParameterAttributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttrs(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009120 NewAttrs.push_back
9121 (ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009122
9123 ++Idx, ++I;
9124 } while (1);
9125 }
9126
9127 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
9128 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009129 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009130
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009131 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009132 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
9133
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009134 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009135 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009136 {
9137 unsigned Idx = 1;
9138 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
9139 E = FTy->param_end();
9140
9141 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009142 if (Idx == NestIdx)
9143 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009144 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009145
9146 if (I == E)
9147 break;
9148
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009149 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009150 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009151
9152 ++Idx, ++I;
9153 } while (1);
9154 }
9155
9156 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
9157 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9158 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009159 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg());
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009160 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
9161 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009162 const PAListPtr &NewPAL = PAListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009163
9164 Instruction *NewCaller;
9165 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009166 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
9167 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9168 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9169 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009170 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009171 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setParamAttrs(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009172 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009173 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9174 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009175 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
9176 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
9177 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
9178 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009179 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setParamAttrs(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009180 }
9181 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9182 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
9183 Caller->eraseFromParent();
9184 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
9185 return 0;
9186 }
9187 }
9188
9189 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
9190 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
9191 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9192 Constant *NewCallee =
9193 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
9194 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
9195 return CS.getInstruction();
9196}
9197
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009198/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
9199/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
9200/// and a single binop.
9201Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9202 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009203 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
9204 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009205 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009206 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9207 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
9208
9209 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
9210 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009211
9212 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
9213 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009214 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009215 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009216 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009217 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009218 // types or GEP's with different index types.
9219 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
9220 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009221 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009222
9223 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
9224 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
9225 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
9226 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
9227 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009228
9229 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
9230 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
9231 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009232 }
9233
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009234 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
9235
9236 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
9237 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
9238 // hide them behind a phi.
9239 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
9240 return 0;
9241
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009242 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009243 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009244 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009245 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009246 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
9247 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009248 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9249 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009250 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
9251 LHSVal = NewLHS;
9252 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009253
9254 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009255 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
9256 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009257 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9258 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009259 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
9260 RHSVal = NewRHS;
9261 }
9262
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009263 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
9264 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9265 if (NewLHS) {
9266 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9267 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9268 }
9269 if (NewRHS) {
9270 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
9271 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9272 }
9273 }
9274
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009275 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009276 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009277 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009278 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009279 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009280 else {
9281 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009282 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009283 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009284}
9285
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009286/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
9287/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
9288/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
9289/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009290///
9291/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
9292/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
9293/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009294static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
9295 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
9296
9297 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
9298 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
9299 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009300
9301 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
9302 // profitable to do this xform.
9303 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
9304 bool isAddressTaken = false;
9305 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
9306 UI != E; ++UI) {
9307 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
9308 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
9309 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
9310 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
9311 }
9312 isAddressTaken = true;
9313 break;
9314 }
9315
9316 if (!isAddressTaken)
9317 return false;
9318 }
9319
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009320 return true;
9321}
9322
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009323
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009324// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
9325// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
9326// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
9327Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9328 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
9329
9330 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
9331 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
9332 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
9333 // code size and simplifying code.
9334 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
9335 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009336 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009337 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
9338 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009339 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009340 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
9341 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009342 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009343 if (ConstantOp == 0)
9344 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009345 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
9346 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
9347 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
9348 // load and the PHI.
9349 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
9350 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9351 return 0;
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009352 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009353 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009354 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
9355 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
9356 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009357 } else {
9358 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
9359 }
9360
9361 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
9362 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9363 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
9364 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009365 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009366 return 0;
9367 if (CastSrcTy) {
9368 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
9369 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009370 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009371 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
9372 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009373 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
9374 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
9375 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9376 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +00009377
9378 // If the PHI is volatile and its block has multiple successors, sinking
9379 // it would remove a load of the volatile value from the path through the
9380 // other successor.
9381 if (isVolatile &&
9382 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9383 return 0;
9384
9385
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009386 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
9387 return 0;
9388 }
9389 }
9390
9391 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
9392 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009393 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
9394 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00009395 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009396
9397 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9398 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009399
9400 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009401 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9402 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9403 if (NewInVal != InVal)
9404 InVal = 0;
9405 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9406 }
9407
9408 Value *PhiVal;
9409 if (InVal) {
9410 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
9411 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
9412 PhiVal = InVal;
9413 delete NewPN;
9414 } else {
9415 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
9416 PhiVal = NewPN;
9417 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009418
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009419 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009420 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009421 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009422 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009423 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009424 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009425 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009426 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009427 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
9428
9429 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
9430 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
9431 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
9432 if (isVolatile)
9433 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
9434 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
9435
9436 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009437}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009438
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009439/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
9440/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009441static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
9442 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009443 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
9444 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
9445
9446 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009447 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009448 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +00009449
9450 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9451 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
9452 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009453
9454 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
9455 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009456
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009457 return false;
9458}
9459
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00009460/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
9461/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
9462/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
9463static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
9464 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
9465 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
9466 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
9467 return true;
9468
9469 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9470 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
9471 return false;
9472
9473 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
9474 // the value.
9475 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9476 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
9477 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
9478 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
9479 return false;
9480 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
9481 return false;
9482 }
9483
9484 return true;
9485}
9486
9487
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00009488// PHINode simplification
9489//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009490Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +00009491 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +00009492 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +00009493
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009494 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
9495 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
9496
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009497 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
9498 // reducing code size.
9499 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
9500 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
9501 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
9502 return Result;
9503
9504 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
9505 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
9506 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00009507 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
9508 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
9509 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009510 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009511 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
9512 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
9513 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
9514 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00009515
9516 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
9517 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
9518 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
9519 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
9520 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
9521 // late.
9522 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
9523 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
9524 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
9525 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
9526 }
9527 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009528
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00009529 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
9530 // same value, for example:
9531 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
9532 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
9533 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
9534 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
9535 {
9536 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
9537 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
9538 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
9539 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
9540 ++InValNo;
9541
9542 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
9543 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
9544
9545 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
9546 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
9547 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
9548 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
9549 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
9550 break;
9551 }
9552
9553 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
9554 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
9555 // the value.
9556 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
9557 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
9558 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
9559 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
9560 }
9561 }
9562 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +00009563 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00009564}
9565
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009566static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
9567 Instruction *InsertPoint,
9568 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00009569 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
9570 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009571 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
9572 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
9573 // used for address computation.
9574 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
9575 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
9576 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
9577 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009578}
9579
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009580
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009581Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009582 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00009583 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009584 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009585 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009586 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009587
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009588 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
9589 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
9590
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009591 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
9592 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
9593 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
9594
9595 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009596 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009597
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009598 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
9599 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009600
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009601 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009602 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
9603 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009604 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009605 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00009606 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
9607 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
9608 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
9609 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
9610 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
9611 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
9612 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009613 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009614 }
9615 }
9616 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009617 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
9618 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
9619 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
9620 // obvious.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009621 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009622 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00009623 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009624 *i = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00009625 MadeChange = true;
9626 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009627 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
9628 GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009629 *i = Op;
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009630 MadeChange = true;
9631 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009632 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009633 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009634 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009635 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
9636
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009637 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
9638 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
9639 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00009640 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices()) {
9641 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))) {
9642 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
9643 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
9644 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
9645 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +00009646 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
9647 if (I != BCI) {
9648 I->takeName(BCI);
9649 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
9650 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
9651 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00009652 return &GEP;
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +00009653 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00009654 }
9655 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
9656 }
9657 }
9658
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009659 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
9660 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
9661 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
9662 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00009663 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00009664 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00009665 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00009666
9667 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009668 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
9669 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
9670 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
9671 //
9672 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
9673 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
9674 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
9675
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00009676 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009677
9678 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
9679 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
9680 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
9681 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +00009682 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009683
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009684 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009685 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +00009686 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
9687 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
9688 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009689 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009690 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
9691 Sum = GO1;
9692 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
9693 Sum = SO1;
9694 } else {
9695 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
9696 // target's pointer size.
9697 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
9698 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009699 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009700 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009701 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009702 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009703 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
9704 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009705 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009706 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009707
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009708 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009709 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009710 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009711 } else {
9712 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009713 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
9714 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009715 }
9716 }
9717 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009718 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
9719 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
9720 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009721 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00009722 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009723 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009724 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009725
9726 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
9727 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
9728 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
9729 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
9730 return &GEP;
9731 } else {
9732 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
9733 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
9734 Indices.push_back(Sum);
9735 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
9736 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009737 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009738 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009739 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009740 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00009741 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
9742 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009743 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
9744 }
9745
9746 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009747 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
9748 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009749
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009750 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009751 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
9752 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
9753
9754 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009755 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009756 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
9757 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
9758 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
9759
9760 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009761 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
9762 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009763
9764 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
9765 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
9766 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009767 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009768 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
9769 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
9770 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009771 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
9772 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009773 //
9774 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
9775 //
9776 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
9777 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
9778 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
9779 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
9780 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
9781 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
9782 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
9783 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
9784 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
9785 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
9786 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
9787 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
9788 return &GEP;
9789 }
9790 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
9791 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009792 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
9793 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009794 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
9795 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
9796 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009797 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
9798 TD->getABITypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009799 Value *Idx[2];
9800 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9801 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009802 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009803 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009804 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
9805 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009806 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009807
9808 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009809 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009810 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009811 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009812
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009813 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009814 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009815 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009816
9817 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
9818 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
9819 Value *NewIdx = 0;
9820 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
9821 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
9822 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
9823 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
9824 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +00009825 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009826 Scale = CI;
9827 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
9828 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
9829 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00009830 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
9831 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
9832 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009833 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
9834 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
9835 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
9836 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
9837 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
9838 }
9839 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009840
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009841 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009842 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
9843 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
9844 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
9845 if (Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
9846 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
9847 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
9848 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009849 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009850 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009851 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009852 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009853 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
9854 }
9855
9856 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009857 Value *Idx[2];
9858 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9859 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009860 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009861 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009862 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
9863 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
9864 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009865 }
9866 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009867 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009868 }
9869
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009870 return 0;
9871}
9872
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009873Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
9874 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009875 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009876 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
9877 const Type *NewTy =
9878 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00009879 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009880
9881 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
9882 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00009883 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00009884 else {
9885 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00009886 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00009887 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009888
9889 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009890
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009891 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
9892 // allocas if possible...
9893 //
9894 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
9895 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
9896
9897 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
9898 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
9899 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009900 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009901 Value *Idx[2];
9902 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
9903 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009904 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
9905 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009906
9907 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
9908 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009909 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009910 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
9911 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009912 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009913 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009914
9915 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
9916 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
9917 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009918 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009919 TD->getABITypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009920 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
9921
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009922 return 0;
9923}
9924
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00009925Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
9926 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
9927
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009928 // free undef -> unreachable.
9929 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
9930 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009931 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009932 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009933 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
9934 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00009935
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00009936 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
9937 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009938 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009939 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00009940
9941 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
9942 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
9943 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
9944 return &FI;
9945 }
9946
9947 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
9948 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
9949 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
9950 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
9951 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
9952 return &FI;
9953 }
9954 }
9955
9956 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
9957 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
9958 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
9959 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
9960 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
9961 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00009962
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00009963 return 0;
9964}
9965
9966
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009967/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +00009968static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00009969 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00009970 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009971 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00009972
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +00009973 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
9974 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
9975 // directly if string length is small enough.
9976 const std::string &Str = CE->getOperand(0)->getStringValue();
9977 if (!Str.empty()) {
9978 unsigned len = Str.length();
9979 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
9980 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
9981 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
9982 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00009983 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
9984 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
9985 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
9986 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
9987 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
9988 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
9989 }
9990 } else {
9991 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
9992 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
9993 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
9994 }
9995 // Append NULL at the end.
9996 SingleChar = 0;
9997 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
9998 }
9999 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
10000 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010001 }
10002 }
10003 }
10004
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010005 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010006 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010007 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010008
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010009 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010010 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010011 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10012 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10013 // constants.
10014 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10015 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10016 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010017 Value *Idxs[2];
10018 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10019 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010020 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10021 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10022 }
10023
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010024 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010025 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000010026 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
10027 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
10028 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010029 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10030 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010031
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010032 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
10033 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
10034 // the result of the loaded value.
10035 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
10036 CI->getName(),
10037 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
10038 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010039 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010040 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010041 }
10042 }
10043 return 0;
10044}
10045
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010046/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010047/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
10048/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
10049/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
10050static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010051 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
10052 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
10053
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010054 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010055 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010056 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010057 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010058
10059 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
10060 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010061 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
10062 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
10063 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010064 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
10065
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010066 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010067 --BBI;
10068
10069 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10070 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
10071 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
10072 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010073
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010074 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010075 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010076}
10077
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010078/// GetUnderlyingObject - Trace through a series of getelementptrs and bitcasts
10079/// until we find the underlying object a pointer is referring to or something
10080/// we don't understand. Note that the returned pointer may be offset from the
10081/// input, because we ignore GEP indices.
10082static Value *GetUnderlyingObject(Value *Ptr) {
10083 while (1) {
10084 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr)) {
10085 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast ||
10086 CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
10087 Ptr = CE->getOperand(0);
10088 else
10089 return Ptr;
10090 } else if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Ptr)) {
10091 Ptr = BCI->getOperand(0);
10092 } else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
10093 Ptr = GEP->getOperand(0);
10094 } else {
10095 return Ptr;
10096 }
10097 }
10098}
10099
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010100Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
10101 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000010102
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010103 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010104 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op);
10105 if (KnownAlign >
10106 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
10107 LI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010108 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10109
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010110 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010111 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010112 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010113 return Res;
10114
10115 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
10116 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010117
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010118 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
10119 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010120 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
10121 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010122 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
10123 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
10124 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010125 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
10126 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
10127 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010128 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010129
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010130 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10131 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
10132 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10133 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
10134 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010135 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10136 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10137 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10138 // CFG.
10139 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10140 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10141 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10142 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010143 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010144
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010145 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010146 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010147 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10148 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
10149 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010150 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
10151 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
10152 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010153 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10154 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010155 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010156 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010157
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010158 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
10159 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010160 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010161 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010162
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010163 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010164 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010165 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
10166 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010167 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000010168 if (Constant *V =
10169 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010170 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010171 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
10172 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10173 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10174 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10175 // CFG.
10176 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10177 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10178 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10179 }
10180
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010181 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010182 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010183 return Res;
10184 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010185 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010186 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010187
10188 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
10189 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
10190 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(GetUnderlyingObject(Op))) {
10191 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
10192 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
10193 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
10194 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
10195 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10196 }
10197 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000010198
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010199 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010200 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
10201 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
10202 // exposes redundancy in the code.
10203 //
10204 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
10205 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
10206 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
10207 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
10208 // unconditionally.
10209 //
10210 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
10211 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010212 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
10213 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010214 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010215 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010216 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010217 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010218 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010219 }
10220
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000010221 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
10222 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
10223 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10224 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
10225 return &LI;
10226 }
10227
10228 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
10229 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
10230 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10231 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
10232 return &LI;
10233 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010234 }
10235 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010236 return 0;
10237}
10238
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000010239/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010240/// when possible.
10241static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
10242 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
10243 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
10244
10245 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10246 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
10247 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10248
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010249 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010250 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10251 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10252 // constants.
10253 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10254 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10255 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010256 Value* Idxs[2];
10257 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10258 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010259 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10260 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10261 }
10262
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010263 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
10264 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10265 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010266
10267 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010268 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
10269 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010270 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010271 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010272 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
10273 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
10274 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
10275 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
10276 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010277 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010278 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +000010279 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010280 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
10281 }
10282 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010283 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010284 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010285 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010286 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010287 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010288 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
10289 }
10290 }
10291 }
10292 return 0;
10293}
10294
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010295Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
10296 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
10297 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
10298
10299 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010300 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010301 ++NumCombined;
10302 return 0;
10303 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010304
10305 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
10306 // alloca dead.
Chris Lattnercea1fdd2008-04-29 04:58:38 +000010307 if (Ptr->hasOneUse() && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010308 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
10309 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10310 ++NumCombined;
10311 return 0;
10312 }
10313
10314 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
10315 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
10316 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
10317 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10318 ++NumCombined;
10319 return 0;
10320 }
10321 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010322
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010323 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010324 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr);
10325 if (KnownAlign >
10326 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
10327 SI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010328 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10329
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010330 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
10331 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
10332 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
10333 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
10334 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10335 --ScanInsts) {
10336 --BBI;
10337
10338 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10339 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
10340 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
10341 ++NumDeadStore;
10342 ++BBI;
10343 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
10344 continue;
10345 }
10346 break;
10347 }
10348
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010349 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
10350 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
10351 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
10352 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattnera54c7eb2007-09-07 05:33:03 +000010353 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010354 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10355 ++NumCombined;
10356 return 0;
10357 }
10358 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
10359 // may not be dead.
10360 break;
10361 }
10362
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010363 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000010364 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010365 break;
10366 }
10367
10368
10369 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010370
10371 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
10372 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
10373 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
10374 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
10375 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010376 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010377 ++NumCombined;
10378 }
10379 return 0; // Do not modify these!
10380 }
10381
10382 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
10383 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010384 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010385 ++NumCombined;
10386 return 0;
10387 }
10388
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010389 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
10390 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010391 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010392 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10393 return Res;
10394 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010395 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010396 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10397 return Res;
10398
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010399
10400 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
10401 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010402 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010403 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010404 if (BI->isUnconditional())
10405 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
10406 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010407
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010408 return 0;
10409}
10410
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010411/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
10412/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
10413/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10414///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010415/// Simplify things like:
10416/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
10417/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10418///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010419bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
10420 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
10421
10422 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
10423 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
10424 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010425 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010426
10427 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
10428 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010429 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
10430 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010431 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010432 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010433 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010434 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010435 return false;
10436
10437 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010438 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010439 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010440 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010441 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010442 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010443 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000010444
10445 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
10446 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
10447 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
10448 return false;
10449
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010450 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
10451 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010452 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010453 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010454 return false;
10455
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010456 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
10457 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
10458 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
10459 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
10460 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
10461 --BBI;
10462 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
10463 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
10464 return false;
10465 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000010466 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010467 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
10468 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
10469 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
10470 return false;
10471
10472 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000010473 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
10474 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010475 for (;; --BBI) {
10476 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
10477 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
10478 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
10479 return false;
10480 break;
10481 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010482 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
10483 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
10484 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010485 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
10486 return false;
10487 }
10488
10489 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010490 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
10491 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010492 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
10493 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010494 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010495 return false;
10496 }
10497 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010498
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010499 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010500 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
10501 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010502 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010503 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
10504 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010505 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
10506 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010507 }
10508
10509 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
10510 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000010511 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010512 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
10513 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
10514
10515 // Nuke the old stores.
10516 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10517 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
10518 ++NumCombined;
10519 return true;
10520}
10521
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010522
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000010523Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
10524 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000010525 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000010526 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
10527 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
10528 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
10529 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
10530 // Swap Destinations and condition...
10531 BI.setCondition(X);
10532 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10533 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
10534 return &BI;
10535 }
10536
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010537 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
10538 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
10539 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
10540 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
10541 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
10542 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
10543 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010544 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010545 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
10546 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010547 // Swap Destinations and condition...
10548 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
10549 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10550 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010551 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010552 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010553 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010554 return &BI;
10555 }
10556
10557 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
10558 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
10559 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
10560 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
10561 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
10562 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
10563 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
10564 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010565 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010566 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
10567 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010568 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000010569 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010570 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10571 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010572 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010573 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010574 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010575 return &BI;
10576 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010577
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000010578 return 0;
10579}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010580
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010581Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
10582 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
10583 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
10584 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
10585 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
10586 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
10587 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010588 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010589 AddRHS));
10590 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010591 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010592 return &SI;
10593 }
10594 }
10595 return 0;
10596}
10597
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000010598Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
10599 // See if we are trying to extract a known value. If so, use that instead.
Matthijs Kooijman710eb232008-06-16 12:57:37 +000010600 if (Value *Elt = FindInsertedValue(EV.getOperand(0), EV.idx_begin(),
Matthijs Kooijman0a7413d2008-06-16 13:13:08 +000010601 EV.idx_end(), &EV))
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000010602 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Elt);
10603
10604 // No changes
10605 return 0;
10606}
10607
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010608/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
10609/// is to leave as a vector operation.
10610static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
10611 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
10612 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010613 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010614 if (isConstant) return true;
10615 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
10616 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
10617 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
10618 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
10619 return false;
10620 return true;
10621 }
10622 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
10623 if (!I) return false;
10624
10625 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
10626 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
10627 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
10628 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
10629 return true;
10630 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
10631 return true;
10632 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
10633 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
10634 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
10635 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
10636 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010637 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
10638 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
10639 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
10640 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
10641 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010642
10643 return false;
10644}
10645
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000010646/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
10647///
10648/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
10649/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010650static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
10651 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
10652 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
10653 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
10654 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
10655 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
10656
10657 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010658 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010659 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
10660 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010661 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
10662 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010663 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010664 return Result;
10665}
10666
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010667/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
10668/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
10669/// extracted from the vector.
10670static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010671 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
10672 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000010673 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
10674 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010675 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
10676
10677 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
10678 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
10679 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
10680 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010681 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010682 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
10683 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
10684 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010685 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
10686 return 0;
10687 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010688
10689 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
10690 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010691 if (EltNo == IIElt)
10692 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010693
10694 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
10695 // vector input.
10696 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000010697 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010698 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
10699 if (InEl < Width)
10700 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
10701 else if (InEl < Width*2)
10702 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
10703 else
10704 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010705 }
10706
10707 // Otherwise, we don't know.
10708 return 0;
10709}
10710
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010711Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000010712 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000010713 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
10714 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
10715
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000010716 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000010717 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
10718 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
10719
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010720 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000010721 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
10722 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
10723 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010724 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010725 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010726 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
10727 op0 = 0;
10728 break;
10729 }
10730 if (op0)
10731 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010732 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010733
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010734 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
10735 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010736 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000010737 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
10738 unsigned VectorWidth =
10739 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
10740
10741 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
10742 // crashing the code below.
10743 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
10744 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
10745
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010746 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
10747 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
10748 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000010749 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010750 uint64_t UndefElts;
10751 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010752 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010753 UndefElts)) {
10754 EI.setOperand(0, V);
10755 return &EI;
10756 }
10757 }
10758
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010759 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010760 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000010761
10762 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
10763 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
10764 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
10765 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
10766 if (const VectorType *VT =
10767 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
10768 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
10769 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
10770 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
10771 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000010772 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010773
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000010774 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010775 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
10776 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
10777 // profitable to do so
10778 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010779 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
10780 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
10781 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
10782 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
10783 EI.getName()+".lhs");
10784 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
10785 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
10786 EI.getName()+".rhs");
10787 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
10788 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010789 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010790 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010791 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010792 unsigned AS =
10793 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000010794 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
10795 PointerType::get(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010796 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
10797 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010798 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
10799 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000010800 }
10801 }
10802 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
10803 // Extracting the inserted element?
10804 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
10805 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
10806 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
10807 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
10808 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
10809 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
10810 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
10811 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
10812 return &EI;
10813 }
10814 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
10815 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
10816 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010817 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
10818 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010819 Value *Src;
10820 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
10821 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
10822 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
10823 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
10824 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
10825 } else {
10826 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000010827 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010828 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010829 }
10830 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000010831 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010832 return 0;
10833}
10834
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010835/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
10836/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
10837/// Otherwise, return false.
10838static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
10839 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
10840 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
10841 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010842 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010843
10844 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010845 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010846 return true;
10847 } else if (V == LHS) {
10848 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010849 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010850 return true;
10851 } else if (V == RHS) {
10852 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010853 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010854 return true;
10855 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
10856 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
10857 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
10858 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
10859 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
10860
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000010861 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
10862 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010863 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000010864
10865 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
10866 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
10867 // transitively ok.
10868 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
10869 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010870 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000010871 return true;
10872 }
10873 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
10874 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010875 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
10876 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010877 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010878
10879 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
10880 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
10881 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
10882 // transitively ok.
10883 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
10884 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
10885 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
10886 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010887 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010888 } else {
10889 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
10890 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010891 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010892
10893 }
10894 return true;
10895 }
10896 }
10897 }
10898 }
10899 }
10900 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
10901
10902 return false;
10903}
10904
10905/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
10906/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
10907/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010908static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010909 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010910 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010911 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010912 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010913 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010914
10915 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010916 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010917 return V;
10918 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010919 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010920 return V;
10921 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
10922 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
10923 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
10924 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
10925 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
10926
10927 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
10928 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
10929 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
10930 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010931 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
10932 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010933
10934 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
10935 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010936 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
10937 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
10938 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010939 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010940 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010941 return V;
10942 }
10943
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010944 if (VecOp == RHS) {
10945 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010946 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
10947 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
10948 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010949 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010950 }
10951 return V;
10952 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010953
10954 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
10955 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
10956 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
10957 return EI->getOperand(0);
10958
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010959 }
10960 }
10961 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010962 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010963
10964 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
10965 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010966 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010967 return V;
10968}
10969
10970Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
10971 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
10972 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
10973 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
10974
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000010975 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
10976 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
10977 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
10978
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010979 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
10980 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
10981 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
10982 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
10983 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
10984 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000010985 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
10986 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010987 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010988
10989 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
10990 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
10991
10992 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
10993 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
10994
10995 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
10996 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
10997 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
10998 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
10999
11000 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
11001 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
11002 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
11003 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
11004 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
11005 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
11006 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
11007 // Build a new shuffle mask.
11008 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
11009 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011010 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011011 else {
11012 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011013 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011014 NumVectorElts));
11015 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011016 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011017 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011018 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011019 }
11020
11021 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
11022 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
11023 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
11024 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011025 Value *RHS = 0;
11026 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
11027 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
11028 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011029 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011030 }
11031 }
11032 }
11033
11034 return 0;
11035}
11036
11037
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011038Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
11039 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11040 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011041 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011042
11043 bool MadeChange = false;
11044
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011045 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011046 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011047 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
11048
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000011049 // If we have shuffle(x, undef, mask) and any elements of mask refer to
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011050 // the undef, change them to undefs.
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000011051 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(1))) {
11052 // Scan to see if there are any references to the RHS. If so, replace them
11053 // with undef element refs and set MadeChange to true.
11054 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11055 if (Mask[i] >= e && Mask[i] != 2*e) {
11056 Mask[i] = 2*e;
11057 MadeChange = true;
11058 }
11059 }
11060
11061 if (MadeChange) {
11062 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11063 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11064 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11065 if (Mask[i] == 2*e)
11066 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11067 else
11068 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
11069 }
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011070 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000011071 }
11072 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011073
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011074 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
11075 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
11076 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
11077 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011078 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
11079 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11080 }
11081
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011082 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11083 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11084 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011085 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011086 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011087 else {
11088 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
11089 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS)))
11090 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
11091 else
11092 Mask[i] &= (e-1); // Force to LHS.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011093 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011094 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011095 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011096 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011097 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011098 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011099 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11100 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011101 MadeChange = true;
11102 }
11103
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011104 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011105 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011106
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011107 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11108 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
11109 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
11110 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
11111
11112 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
11113 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011114 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011115
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011116 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
11117 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11118 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011119
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011120 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
11121 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
11122 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
11123 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
11124 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
11125 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
11126 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
11127 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
11128 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
11129 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
11130 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
11131 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
11132
11133 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
11134 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
11135 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
11136 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
11137 else
11138 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
11139
11140 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
11141 // the replacement.
11142 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
11143 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11144 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11145 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011146 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011147 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011148 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011149 }
11150 }
11151 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
11152 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011153 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011154 }
11155 }
11156 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000011157
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011158 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
11159}
11160
11161
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011162
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011163
11164/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
11165/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
11166/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
11167/// end of its block.
11168static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
11169 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
11170
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000011171 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000011172 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
11173 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011174
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011175 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000011176 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
11177 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011178 return false;
11179
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011180 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
11181 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000011182 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
11183 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011184 Scan != E; ++Scan)
11185 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
11186 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011187 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011188
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011189 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011190
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000011191 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011192 ++NumSunkInst;
11193 return true;
11194}
11195
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011196
11197/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
11198/// all reachable code to the worklist.
11199///
11200/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
11201/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
11202/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
11203/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
11204/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
11205///
11206static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011207 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011208 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011209 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011210 std::vector<BasicBlock*> Worklist;
11211 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011212
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011213 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11214 BB = Worklist.back();
11215 Worklist.pop_back();
11216
11217 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
11218 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
11219
11220 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
11221 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011222
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011223 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
11224 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
11225 ++NumDeadInst;
11226 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
11227 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11228 continue;
11229 }
11230
11231 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
11232 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
11233 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
11234 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
11235 ++NumConstProp;
11236 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11237 continue;
11238 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000011239
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011240 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011241 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011242
11243 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
11244 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
11245 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
11246 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
11247 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
11248 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011249 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011250 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011251 continue;
11252 }
11253 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
11254 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
11255 // See if this is an explicit destination.
11256 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11257 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011258 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011259 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011260 continue;
11261 }
11262
11263 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
11264 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
11265 continue;
11266 }
11267 }
11268
11269 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11270 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011271 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011272}
11273
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011274bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011275 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000011276 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011277
11278 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
11279 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011280
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011281 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011282 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
11283 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
11284 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011285 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011286 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000011287
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011288 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
11289 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
11290 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
11291 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
11292 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
11293 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
11294 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
11295 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000011296
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011297 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011298 ++NumDeadInst;
11299
11300 if (!I->use_empty())
11301 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
11302 I->eraseFromParent();
11303 }
11304 }
11305 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011306
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011307 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11308 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
11309 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011310
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011311 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011312 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011313 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011314 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011315 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011316 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011317
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011318 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011319
11320 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011321 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011322 continue;
11323 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011324
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011325 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000011326 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011327 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011328
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011329 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011330 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000011331 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
11332
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011333 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011334 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011335 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011336 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011337 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011338
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000011339 if (TD && I->getType()->getTypeID() == Type::VoidTyID) {
11340 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
11341 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i) {
11342 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i)) {
11343 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD))
11344 i->set(NewC);
11345 }
11346 }
11347 }
11348
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011349 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000011350 // FIXME: Remove GetResultInst test when first class support for aggregates
11351 // is implemented.
Devang Patelf944c9a2008-05-03 00:36:30 +000011352 if (I->hasOneUse() && !isa<GetResultInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011353 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
11354 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
11355 if (UserParent != BB) {
11356 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
11357 // See if the user is one of our successors.
11358 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
11359 if (*SI == UserParent) {
11360 UserIsSuccessor = true;
11361 break;
11362 }
11363
11364 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
11365 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
11366 // otherwise), we can keep going.
11367 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
11368 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
11369 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
11370 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
11371 }
11372 }
11373
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011374 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000011375#ifndef NDEBUG
11376 std::string OrigI;
11377#endif
11378 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011379 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000011380 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011381 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000011382 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011383 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
11384 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000011385
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011386 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
11387 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
11388
11389 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011390 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011391 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011392
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011393 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
11394 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011395
11396 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
11397 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011398 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
11399
11400 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
11401 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
11402 ++InsertPos;
11403
11404 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011405
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011406 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
11407 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011408 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000011409
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011410 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
11411 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011412 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011413
11414 // Erase the old instruction.
11415 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000011416 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000011417#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000011418 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
11419 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000011420#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000011421
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011422 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
11423 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011424 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
11425 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
11426 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011427 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011428
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011429 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011430 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011431 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011432 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011433 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011434 AddToWorkList(I);
11435 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011436 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000011437 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011438 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011439 }
11440 }
11441
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011442 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000011443
11444 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
11445 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011446 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000011447}
11448
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011449
11450bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000011451 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
11452
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011453 bool EverMadeChange = false;
11454
11455 // Iterate while there is work to do.
11456 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000011457 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011458 EverMadeChange = true;
11459 return EverMadeChange;
11460}
11461
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000011462FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011463 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000011464}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000011465